1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===// 2 // 3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure 4 // 5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source 6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details. 7 // 8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 9 // 10 // This file implements semantic analysis for expressions. 11 // 12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13 14 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 15 #include "TreeTransform.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h" 28 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 32 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" 34 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h" 35 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 36 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 37 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 45 using namespace clang; 46 using namespace sema; 47 48 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without 49 /// emitting diagnostics. 50 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D) { 51 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 52 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) 53 return false; 54 55 // See if this is a deleted function. 56 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 57 if (FD->isDeleted()) 58 return false; 59 60 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 61 // then we can't use it either. 62 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 63 DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false)) 64 return false; 65 } 66 67 // See if this function is unavailable. 68 if (D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable && 69 cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) 70 return false; 71 72 return true; 73 } 74 75 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) { 76 // Warn if this is used but marked unused. 77 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 78 const Decl *DC = cast<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext()); 79 if (!DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 80 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName(); 81 } 82 } 83 84 static AvailabilityResult DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(Sema &S, 85 NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 86 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, 87 bool ObjCPropertyAccess) { 88 // See if this declaration is unavailable or deprecated. 89 std::string Message; 90 91 // Forward class declarations get their attributes from their definition. 92 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 93 if (IDecl->getDefinition()) 94 D = IDecl->getDefinition(); 95 } 96 AvailabilityResult Result = D->getAvailability(&Message); 97 if (const EnumConstantDecl *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D)) 98 if (Result == AR_Available) { 99 const DeclContext *DC = ECD->getDeclContext(); 100 if (const EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(DC)) 101 Result = TheEnumDecl->getAvailability(&Message); 102 } 103 104 const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = nullptr; 105 if (Result == AR_Deprecated || Result == AR_Unavailable) { 106 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 107 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = MD->findPropertyDecl()) { 108 AvailabilityResult PDeclResult = PD->getAvailability(nullptr); 109 if (PDeclResult == Result) 110 ObjCPDecl = PD; 111 } 112 } 113 } 114 115 switch (Result) { 116 case AR_Available: 117 case AR_NotYetIntroduced: 118 break; 119 120 case AR_Deprecated: 121 if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Deprecated) 122 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Deprecation, 123 D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl, 124 ObjCPropertyAccess); 125 break; 126 127 case AR_Unavailable: 128 if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) 129 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Unavailable, 130 D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl, 131 ObjCPropertyAccess); 132 break; 133 134 } 135 return Result; 136 } 137 138 /// \brief Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted. 139 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) { 140 assert(Decl->isDeleted()); 141 142 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl); 143 144 if (Method && Method->isDeleted() && Method->isDefaulted()) { 145 // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration. 146 if (!Method->isImplicit()) 147 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted); 148 149 // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly 150 // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies. 151 CXXSpecialMember CSM = getSpecialMember(Method); 152 if (CSM != CXXInvalid) 153 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Method, CSM, /*Diagnose=*/true); 154 155 return; 156 } 157 158 if (CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl)) { 159 if (CXXConstructorDecl *BaseCD = 160 const_cast<CXXConstructorDecl*>(CD->getInheritedConstructor())) { 161 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_inherited_deleted_here); 162 if (BaseCD->isDeleted()) { 163 NoteDeletedFunction(BaseCD); 164 } else { 165 // FIXME: An explanation of why exactly it can't be inherited 166 // would be nice. 167 Diag(BaseCD->getLocation(), diag::note_cannot_inherit); 168 } 169 return; 170 } 171 } 172 173 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here) 174 << Decl << true; 175 } 176 177 /// \brief Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an 178 /// explicit storage class. 179 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) { 180 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 181 if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None) 182 return true; 183 } 184 return false; 185 } 186 187 /// \brief Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a 188 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3). 189 /// 190 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but 191 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode 192 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6) 193 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't 194 /// prove that there are errors. 195 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S, 196 const NamedDecl *D, 197 SourceLocation Loc) { 198 // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in 199 // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically 200 // correct but benign. 201 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 202 return; 203 204 // Check if this is an inlined function or method. 205 FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl(); 206 if (!Current) 207 return; 208 if (!Current->isInlined()) 209 return; 210 if (!Current->isExternallyVisible()) 211 return; 212 213 // Check if the decl has internal linkage. 214 if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage) 215 return; 216 217 // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if 218 // (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file, 219 // and probably won't be included anywhere else. 220 // (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function. 221 // (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function. 222 // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on 223 // wrappers for simple C library functions. 224 const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 225 bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc); 226 if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn) 227 DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>(); 228 229 S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline 230 : diag::warn_internal_in_extern_inline) 231 << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D; 232 233 S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current); 234 235 S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 236 << D; 237 } 238 239 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) { 240 const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl(); 241 242 // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible. 243 if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) { 244 SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin(); 245 Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static) 246 << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static "); 247 } 248 } 249 250 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and 251 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics. 252 /// 253 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing 254 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example, 255 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being 256 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted 257 /// function is being used. 258 /// 259 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be 260 /// referenced), false otherwise. 261 /// 262 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 263 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, 264 bool ObjCPropertyAccess) { 265 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 266 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction, 267 // emit them now. 268 SuppressedDiagnosticsMap::iterator 269 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl()); 270 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) { 271 SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second; 272 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I) 273 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second); 274 275 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit 276 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this 277 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these 278 // diagnostics again. 279 Suppressed.clear(); 280 } 281 282 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3: 283 // The function 'main' shall not be used within a program. 284 if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain()) 285 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used); 286 } 287 288 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 289 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) { 290 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer) 291 << D->getDeclName(); 292 return true; 293 } 294 295 // See if this is a deleted function. 296 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 297 if (FD->isDeleted()) { 298 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use); 299 NoteDeletedFunction(FD); 300 return true; 301 } 302 303 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 304 // then we can't use it either. 305 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 306 DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc)) 307 return true; 308 } 309 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(*this, D, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPropertyAccess); 310 311 DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc); 312 313 diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc); 314 315 return false; 316 } 317 318 /// \brief Retrieve the message suffix that should be added to a 319 /// diagnostic complaining about the given function being deleted or 320 /// unavailable. 321 std::string Sema::getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(const FunctionDecl *FD) { 322 std::string Message; 323 if (FD->getAvailability(&Message)) 324 return ": " + Message; 325 326 return std::string(); 327 } 328 329 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or 330 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and 331 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are 332 /// satisfied. 333 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 334 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 335 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>(); 336 if (!attr) 337 return; 338 339 // The number of formal parameters of the declaration. 340 unsigned numFormalParams; 341 342 // The kind of declaration. This is also an index into a %select in 343 // the diagnostic. 344 enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType; 345 346 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 347 numFormalParams = MD->param_size(); 348 calleeType = CT_Method; 349 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 350 numFormalParams = FD->param_size(); 351 calleeType = CT_Function; 352 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 353 QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType(); 354 const FunctionType *fn = nullptr; 355 if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 356 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 357 if (!fn) return; 358 calleeType = CT_Function; 359 } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 360 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 361 calleeType = CT_Block; 362 } else { 363 return; 364 } 365 366 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) { 367 numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams(); 368 } else { 369 numFormalParams = 0; 370 } 371 } else { 372 return; 373 } 374 375 // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which 376 // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments. This is 377 // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters, 378 // but the language forces you to have at least one. 379 unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos(); 380 assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel"); 381 numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos); 382 383 // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel. 384 unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel(); 385 386 // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters, 387 // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain. 388 if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) { 389 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName(); 390 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 391 return; 392 } 393 394 // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression. 395 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1]; 396 if (!sentinelExpr) return; 397 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return; 398 if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return; 399 400 // Pick a reasonable string to insert. Optimistically use 'nil' or 401 // 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context. Only use 402 // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the 403 // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers. 404 SourceLocation MissingNilLoc 405 = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getLocEnd()); 406 std::string NullValue; 407 if (calleeType == CT_Method && 408 PP.getIdentifierInfo("nil")->hasMacroDefinition()) 409 NullValue = "nil"; 410 else if (PP.getIdentifierInfo("NULL")->hasMacroDefinition()) 411 NullValue = "NULL"; 412 else 413 NullValue = "(void*) 0"; 414 415 if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid()) 416 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType); 417 else 418 Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) 419 << int(calleeType) 420 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue); 421 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 422 } 423 424 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const { 425 return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange(); 426 } 427 428 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 429 // Standard Promotions and Conversions 430 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 431 432 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4). 433 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E) { 434 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 435 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 436 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 437 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 438 E = result.get(); 439 } 440 441 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 442 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type"); 443 444 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 445 // If we are here, we are not calling a function but taking 446 // its address (which is not allowed in OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3). 447 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 448 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address); 449 return ExprError(); 450 } 451 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 452 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 453 } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) { 454 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is 455 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has 456 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer 457 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression 458 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue" 459 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99). 460 // 461 // C++ 4.2p1: 462 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of 463 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T". 464 // 465 if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue()) 466 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty), 467 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 468 } 469 return E; 470 } 471 472 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 473 // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer. If so, 474 // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the 475 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this 476 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This 477 // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check. 478 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 479 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref && 480 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()-> 481 isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) && 482 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) { 483 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 484 S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null) 485 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange()); 486 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 487 S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null)); 488 } 489 } 490 491 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE, 492 SourceLocation AssignLoc, 493 const Expr* RHS) { 494 const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl(); 495 if (!IV) 496 return; 497 498 DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName(); 499 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 500 if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa")) 501 return; 502 503 const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase(); 504 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 505 if (OIRE->isArrow()) 506 BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType(); 507 if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) 508 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) { 509 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr; 510 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared); 511 if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass() 512 && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) { 513 if (RHS) { 514 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = 515 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 516 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 517 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 518 if (ObjectSetClass) { 519 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getLocEnd()); 520 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) << 521 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") << 522 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), 523 AssignLoc), ",") << 524 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 525 } 526 else 527 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 528 } else { 529 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = 530 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 531 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 532 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 533 if (ObjectGetClass) 534 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) << 535 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") << 536 FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 537 SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), 538 OIRE->getLocEnd()), ")"); 539 else 540 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 541 } 542 S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl); 543 } 544 } 545 } 546 547 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) { 548 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 549 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 550 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 551 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 552 E = result.get(); 553 } 554 555 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 556 // A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be 557 // converted to a prvalue. 558 if (!E->isGLValue()) return E; 559 560 QualType T = E->getType(); 561 assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?"); 562 563 // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of 564 // expressions of certain types in C++. 565 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 566 (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy || 567 T->isDependentType() || 568 T->isRecordType())) 569 return E; 570 571 // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and 572 // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why. It's 573 // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo 574 // lvalue-to-rvalue at all. Note that expressions of unqualified 575 // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be. 576 if (T->isVoidType()) 577 return E; 578 579 // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type. 580 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp16 && 581 T->isHalfType()) { 582 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) 583 << 0 << T; 584 return ExprError(); 585 } 586 587 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E); 588 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 589 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 590 &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 591 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 592 if (ObjectGetClass) 593 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) << 594 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") << 595 FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 596 SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")"); 597 else 598 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 599 } 600 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 601 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 602 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr); 603 604 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 605 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the 606 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the 607 // rvalue is T. 608 // 609 // C99 6.3.2.1p2: 610 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified 611 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the 612 // type of the lvalue. 613 if (T.hasQualifiers()) 614 T = T.getUnqualifiedType(); 615 616 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E); 617 618 // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to 619 // balance that. 620 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 621 E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 622 ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 623 624 ExprResult Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_LValueToRValue, E, 625 nullptr, VK_RValue); 626 627 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 628 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 629 // of the type of the lvalue ... 630 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) { 631 T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType(); 632 Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(), 633 nullptr, VK_RValue); 634 } 635 636 return Res; 637 } 638 639 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E) { 640 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E); 641 if (Res.isInvalid()) 642 return ExprError(); 643 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 644 if (Res.isInvalid()) 645 return ExprError(); 646 return Res; 647 } 648 649 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion 650 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression. 651 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 652 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 653 ExprResult Res = E; 654 // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer 655 // to function type. 656 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 657 Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 658 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 659 if (Res.isInvalid()) 660 return ExprError(); 661 } 662 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 663 if (Res.isInvalid()) 664 return ExprError(); 665 return Res.get(); 666 } 667 668 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most 669 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are 670 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't 671 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators. 672 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called. 673 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 674 // First, convert to an r-value. 675 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 676 if (Res.isInvalid()) 677 return ExprError(); 678 E = Res.get(); 679 680 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 681 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type"); 682 683 // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported 684 if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) 685 return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast); 686 687 // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically 688 // promotable type. 689 if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 690 // C99 6.3.1.1p2: 691 // 692 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or 693 // unsigned int may be used: 694 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer 695 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int 696 // and unsigned int. 697 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int. 698 // 699 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the 700 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an 701 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All 702 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions. 703 704 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E); 705 if (!PTy.isNull()) { 706 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 707 return E; 708 } 709 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 710 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty); 711 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 712 return E; 713 } 714 } 715 return E; 716 } 717 718 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that 719 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16 720 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by 721 /// UsualUnaryConversions(). 722 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) { 723 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 724 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type"); 725 726 ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 727 if (Res.isInvalid()) 728 return ExprError(); 729 E = Res.get(); 730 731 // If this is a 'float' or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to 732 // double. 733 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 734 if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half || 735 BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)) 736 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 737 738 // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument 739 // promotion, even on class types, but note: 740 // C++11 [conv.lval]p2: 741 // When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated 742 // operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the 743 // referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue 744 // has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary 745 // of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion 746 // is a prvalue for the temporary. 747 // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in 748 // potentially potentially evaluated contexts. 749 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) { 750 ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization( 751 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()), 752 E->getExprLoc(), E); 753 if (Temp.isInvalid()) 754 return ExprError(); 755 E = Temp.get(); 756 } 757 758 return E; 759 } 760 761 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression. 762 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed 763 /// when we're in an unevaluated context. 764 Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) { 765 if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) { 766 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 767 // After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic, 768 // enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program 769 // is ill-formed. 770 // 771 // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer 772 // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles 773 // initializer lists as variadic arguments. 774 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 775 return VAK_Invalid; 776 777 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 778 return VAK_Invalid; 779 return VAK_Valid; 780 } 781 782 if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context)) 783 return VAK_Valid; 784 785 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 786 // Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9) 787 // having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor, 788 // or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter, 789 // is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics. 790 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType()) 791 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 792 if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() && 793 !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() && 794 !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 795 return VAK_ValidInCXX11; 796 797 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType()) 798 return VAK_Valid; 799 800 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 801 return VAK_Invalid; 802 803 // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're 804 // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so. 805 return VAK_Undefined; 806 } 807 808 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) { 809 // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg. 810 const QualType &Ty = E->getType(); 811 VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty); 812 813 // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs. 814 switch (VAK) { 815 case VAK_ValidInCXX11: 816 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 817 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 818 PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 819 << Ty << CT); 820 // Fall through. 821 case VAK_Valid: 822 if (Ty->isRecordType()) { 823 // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a 824 // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that. 825 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 826 PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg) 827 << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()"); 828 } 829 break; 830 831 case VAK_Undefined: 832 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 833 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 834 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 835 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT); 836 break; 837 838 case VAK_Invalid: 839 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 840 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 841 E->getLocStart(), nullptr, 842 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg) 843 << Ty << CT); 844 else 845 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg) 846 << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT; 847 break; 848 } 849 } 850 851 /// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but 852 /// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type. 853 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT, 854 FunctionDecl *FDecl) { 855 if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 856 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 857 if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 858 (CT == VariadicMethod || 859 (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) { 860 E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 861 862 // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking. 863 } else { 864 ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 865 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 866 return ExprError(); 867 E = ExprRes.get(); 868 } 869 } 870 871 ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E); 872 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 873 return ExprError(); 874 E = ExprRes.get(); 875 876 // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are 877 // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall(). 878 if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) { 879 // Turn this into a trap. 880 CXXScopeSpec SS; 881 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 882 UnqualifiedId Name; 883 Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"), 884 E->getLocStart()); 885 ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc, 886 Name, true, false); 887 if (TrapFn.isInvalid()) 888 return ExprError(); 889 890 ExprResult Call = ActOnCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(), 891 E->getLocStart(), None, 892 E->getLocEnd()); 893 if (Call.isInvalid()) 894 return ExprError(); 895 896 ExprResult Comma = ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getLocStart(), tok::comma, 897 Call.get(), E); 898 if (Comma.isInvalid()) 899 return ExprError(); 900 return Comma.get(); 901 } 902 903 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 904 RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(), 905 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)) 906 return ExprError(); 907 908 return E; 909 } 910 911 /// \brief Converts an integer to complex float type. Helper function of 912 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 913 /// 914 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is 915 /// successfully converted to the complex type. 916 static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr, 917 ExprResult &ComplexExpr, 918 QualType IntTy, 919 QualType ComplexTy, 920 bool SkipCast) { 921 if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true; 922 if (SkipCast) return false; 923 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 924 QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType(); 925 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating); 926 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 927 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 928 } else { 929 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 930 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 931 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 932 } 933 return false; 934 } 935 936 /// \brief Takes two complex float types and converts them to the same type. 937 /// Helper function of UsualArithmeticConversions() 938 static QualType 939 handleComplexFloatToComplexFloatConverstion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 940 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 941 QualType RHSType, 942 bool IsCompAssign) { 943 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 944 945 if (order < 0) { 946 // _Complex float -> _Complex double 947 if (!IsCompAssign) 948 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 949 return RHSType; 950 } 951 if (order > 0) 952 // _Complex float -> _Complex double 953 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 954 return LHSType; 955 } 956 957 /// \brief Converts otherExpr to complex float and promotes complexExpr if 958 /// necessary. Helper function of UsualArithmeticConversions() 959 static QualType handleOtherComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, 960 ExprResult &ComplexExpr, 961 ExprResult &OtherExpr, 962 QualType ComplexTy, 963 QualType OtherTy, 964 bool ConvertComplexExpr, 965 bool ConvertOtherExpr) { 966 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(ComplexTy, OtherTy); 967 968 // If just the complexExpr is complex, the otherExpr needs to be converted, 969 // and the complexExpr might need to be promoted. 970 if (order > 0) { // complexExpr is wider 971 // float -> _Complex double 972 if (ConvertOtherExpr) { 973 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType(); 974 OtherExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr.get(), fp, CK_FloatingCast); 975 OtherExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 976 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 977 } 978 return ComplexTy; 979 } 980 981 // otherTy is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type. 982 QualType result = (order == 0 ? ComplexTy : 983 S.Context.getComplexType(OtherTy)); 984 985 // double -> _Complex double 986 if (ConvertOtherExpr) 987 OtherExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr.get(), result, 988 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 989 990 // _Complex float -> _Complex double 991 if (ConvertComplexExpr && order < 0) 992 ComplexExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(ComplexExpr.get(), result, 993 CK_FloatingComplexCast); 994 995 return result; 996 } 997 998 /// \brief Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types. Helper function of 999 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 1000 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1001 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1002 QualType RHSType, 1003 bool IsCompAssign) { 1004 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type. 1005 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 1006 /*skipCast*/false)) 1007 return LHSType; 1008 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1009 /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign)) 1010 return RHSType; 1011 1012 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex. 1013 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the 1014 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds 1015 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands. 1016 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains. 1017 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real 1018 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's 1019 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example, 1020 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the 1021 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex". 1022 1023 bool LHSComplexFloat = LHSType->isComplexType(); 1024 bool RHSComplexFloat = RHSType->isComplexType(); 1025 1026 // If both are complex, just cast to the more precise type. 1027 if (LHSComplexFloat && RHSComplexFloat) 1028 return handleComplexFloatToComplexFloatConverstion(S, LHS, RHS, 1029 LHSType, RHSType, 1030 IsCompAssign); 1031 1032 // If only one operand is complex, promote it if necessary and convert the 1033 // other operand to complex. 1034 if (LHSComplexFloat) 1035 return handleOtherComplexFloatConversion( 1036 S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*convertComplexExpr*/!IsCompAssign, 1037 /*convertOtherExpr*/ true); 1038 1039 assert(RHSComplexFloat); 1040 return handleOtherComplexFloatConversion( 1041 S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, /*convertComplexExpr*/true, 1042 /*convertOtherExpr*/ !IsCompAssign); 1043 } 1044 1045 /// \brief Hande arithmetic conversion from integer to float. Helper function 1046 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1047 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr, 1048 ExprResult &IntExpr, 1049 QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy, 1050 bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) { 1051 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 1052 if (ConvertInt) 1053 // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type. 1054 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy, 1055 CK_IntegralToFloating); 1056 return FloatTy; 1057 } 1058 1059 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float. 1060 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 1061 QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy); 1062 1063 // _Complex int -> _Complex float 1064 if (ConvertInt) 1065 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result, 1066 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 1067 1068 // float -> _Complex float 1069 if (ConvertFloat) 1070 FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result, 1071 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 1072 1073 return result; 1074 } 1075 1076 /// \brief Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types. Helper 1077 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1078 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1079 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1080 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1081 bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1082 bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1083 1084 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand 1085 // to the bigger result. 1086 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) { 1087 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1088 if (order > 0) { 1089 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1090 return LHSType; 1091 } 1092 1093 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison"); 1094 if (!IsCompAssign) 1095 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1096 return RHSType; 1097 } 1098 1099 if (LHSFloat) 1100 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1101 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign, 1102 /*convertInt=*/ true); 1103 assert(RHSFloat); 1104 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 1105 /*convertInt=*/ true, 1106 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign); 1107 } 1108 1109 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType); 1110 1111 namespace { 1112 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to 1113 /// permit their use as function template parameters. 1114 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1115 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast); 1116 } 1117 1118 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1119 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType), 1120 CK_IntegralComplexCast); 1121 } 1122 } 1123 1124 /// \brief Handle integer arithmetic conversions. Helper function of 1125 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 1126 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast> 1127 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1128 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1129 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1130 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8 1131 int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1132 bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1133 bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1134 if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) { 1135 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type 1136 if (order >= 0) { 1137 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1138 return LHSType; 1139 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1140 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1141 return RHSType; 1142 } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) { 1143 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the 1144 // signed type, so use the unsigned type 1145 if (RHSSigned) { 1146 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1147 return LHSType; 1148 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1149 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1150 return RHSType; 1151 } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) { 1152 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that 1153 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so 1154 // use the signed type. 1155 if (LHSSigned) { 1156 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1157 return LHSType; 1158 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1159 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1160 return RHSType; 1161 } else { 1162 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type, 1163 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long 1164 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding 1165 // to the signed type. 1166 QualType result = 1167 S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType); 1168 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result); 1169 if (!IsCompAssign) 1170 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result); 1171 return result; 1172 } 1173 } 1174 1175 /// \brief Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension. Helper function 1176 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1177 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1178 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1179 QualType RHSType, 1180 bool IsCompAssign) { 1181 const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1182 const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1183 1184 if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) { 1185 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1186 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1187 QualType ScalarType = 1188 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1189 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1190 1191 return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1192 } 1193 1194 if (LHSComplexInt) { 1195 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1196 QualType ScalarType = 1197 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1198 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1199 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1200 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType, 1201 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1202 1203 return ComplexType; 1204 } 1205 1206 assert(RHSComplexInt); 1207 1208 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1209 QualType ScalarType = 1210 handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1211 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1212 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1213 1214 if (!IsCompAssign) 1215 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType, 1216 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1217 return ComplexType; 1218 } 1219 1220 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to 1221 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this 1222 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is 1223 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics. 1224 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 1225 bool IsCompAssign) { 1226 if (!IsCompAssign) { 1227 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 1228 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 1229 return QualType(); 1230 } 1231 1232 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 1233 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 1234 return QualType(); 1235 1236 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 1237 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 1238 QualType LHSType = 1239 Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1240 QualType RHSType = 1241 Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1242 1243 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS. 1244 if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1245 LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType(); 1246 1247 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1248 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1249 return LHSType; 1250 1251 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done. 1252 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int). 1253 if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType()) 1254 return QualType(); 1255 1256 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type. 1257 QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType; 1258 if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 1259 LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType); 1260 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 1261 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull()) 1262 LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy; 1263 if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign) 1264 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast); 1265 1266 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1267 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1268 return LHSType; 1269 1270 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types. 1271 1272 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1). 1273 if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType()) 1274 return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1275 IsCompAssign); 1276 1277 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 1278 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 1279 return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1280 IsCompAssign); 1281 1282 // Handle GCC complex int extension. 1283 if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType()) 1284 return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1285 IsCompAssign); 1286 1287 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 1288 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1289 (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1290 } 1291 1292 1293 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1294 // Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types 1295 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1296 1297 1298 ExprResult 1299 Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1300 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1301 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1302 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1303 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes, 1304 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) { 1305 unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size(); 1306 assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size()); 1307 1308 TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs]; 1309 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1310 if (ArgTypes[i]) 1311 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]); 1312 else 1313 Types[i] = nullptr; 1314 } 1315 1316 ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1317 ControllingExpr, 1318 llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs), 1319 ArgExprs); 1320 delete [] Types; 1321 return ER; 1322 } 1323 1324 ExprResult 1325 Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1326 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1327 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1328 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1329 ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types, 1330 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) { 1331 unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size(); 1332 assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size()); 1333 if (ControllingExpr->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 1334 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(ControllingExpr); 1335 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 1336 ControllingExpr = result.get(); 1337 } 1338 1339 bool TypeErrorFound = false, 1340 IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(), 1341 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack 1342 = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(); 1343 1344 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1345 if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1346 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1347 1348 if (Types[i]) { 1349 if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1350 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1351 1352 if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1353 IsResultDependent = true; 1354 } else { 1355 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a 1356 // complete object type other than a variably modified type." 1357 unsigned D = 0; 1358 if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) 1359 D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete; 1360 else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType()) 1361 D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject; 1362 else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 1363 D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified; 1364 1365 if (D != 0) { 1366 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D) 1367 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1368 << Types[i]->getType(); 1369 TypeErrorFound = true; 1370 } 1371 1372 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic 1373 // selection shall specify compatible types." 1374 for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j) 1375 if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() && 1376 Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(), 1377 Types[j]->getType())) { 1378 Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1379 diag::err_assoc_compatible_types) 1380 << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1381 << Types[j]->getType() 1382 << Types[i]->getType(); 1383 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1384 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1385 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1386 << Types[i]->getType(); 1387 TypeErrorFound = true; 1388 } 1389 } 1390 } 1391 } 1392 if (TypeErrorFound) 1393 return ExprError(); 1394 1395 // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't 1396 // try to compute the result expression. 1397 if (IsResultDependent) 1398 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 1399 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1400 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack); 1401 1402 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices; 1403 unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U; 1404 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1405 if (!Types[i]) 1406 DefaultIndex = i; 1407 else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(), 1408 Types[i]->getType())) 1409 CompatIndices.push_back(i); 1410 } 1411 1412 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have 1413 // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic 1414 // association list." 1415 if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) { 1416 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1417 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1418 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1419 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match) 1420 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType() 1421 << (unsigned) CompatIndices.size(); 1422 for (SmallVectorImpl<unsigned>::iterator I = CompatIndices.begin(), 1423 E = CompatIndices.end(); I != E; ++I) { 1424 Diag(Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1425 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1426 << Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1427 << Types[*I]->getType(); 1428 } 1429 return ExprError(); 1430 } 1431 1432 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association, 1433 // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of 1434 // the types named in its generic association list." 1435 if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) { 1436 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1437 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1438 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1439 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match) 1440 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType(); 1441 return ExprError(); 1442 } 1443 1444 // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a 1445 // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression, 1446 // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression 1447 // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the 1448 // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association." 1449 unsigned ResultIndex = 1450 CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex; 1451 1452 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr( 1453 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1454 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex); 1455 } 1456 1457 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the 1458 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it. 1459 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 1460 unsigned Offset) { 1461 return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(), 1462 S.getLangOpts()); 1463 } 1464 1465 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up 1466 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it. 1467 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope, 1468 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix, 1469 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc, 1470 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 1471 SourceLocation LitEndLoc) { 1472 assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator"); 1473 1474 QualType ArgTy[2]; 1475 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 1476 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType(); 1477 if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType()) 1478 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]); 1479 } 1480 1481 DeclarationName OpName = 1482 S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1483 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1484 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1485 1486 LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 1487 if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()), 1488 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false, 1489 /*AllowStringTemplate*/false) == Sema::LOLR_Error) 1490 return ExprError(); 1491 1492 return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc); 1493 } 1494 1495 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string 1496 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string 1497 /// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from 1498 /// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one 1499 /// string. 1500 /// 1501 ExprResult 1502 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) { 1503 assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!"); 1504 1505 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP); 1506 if (Literal.hadError) 1507 return ExprError(); 1508 1509 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs; 1510 for (unsigned i = 0; i != StringToks.size(); ++i) 1511 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation()); 1512 1513 QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy; 1514 StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii; 1515 if (Literal.isWide()) { 1516 CharTy = Context.getWideCharType(); 1517 Kind = StringLiteral::Wide; 1518 } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) { 1519 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8; 1520 } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) { 1521 CharTy = Context.Char16Ty; 1522 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16; 1523 } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) { 1524 CharTy = Context.Char32Ty; 1525 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32; 1526 } else if (Literal.isPascal()) { 1527 CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 1528 } 1529 1530 QualType CharTyConst = CharTy; 1531 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1). 1532 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || getLangOpts().ConstStrings) 1533 CharTyConst.addConst(); 1534 1535 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes 1536 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal 1537 // strings. 1538 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(CharTyConst, 1539 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1), 1540 ArrayType::Normal, 0); 1541 1542 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: a string literal is in the constant address space. 1543 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 1544 StrTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(StrTy, LangAS::opencl_constant); 1545 } 1546 1547 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory! 1548 StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(), 1549 Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy, 1550 &StringTokLocs[0], 1551 StringTokLocs.size()); 1552 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 1553 return Lit; 1554 1555 // We're building a user-defined literal. 1556 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 1557 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 1558 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()], 1559 Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 1560 1561 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 1562 if (!UDLScope) 1563 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl)); 1564 1565 // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 1566 // operator "" X (str, len) 1567 QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType(); 1568 1569 DeclarationName OpName = 1570 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1571 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1572 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1573 1574 QualType ArgTy[] = { 1575 Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType 1576 }; 1577 1578 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1579 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy, 1580 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false, 1581 /*AllowStringTemplate*/true)) { 1582 1583 case LOLR_Cooked: { 1584 llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars()); 1585 IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType, 1586 StringTokLocs[0]); 1587 Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg }; 1588 1589 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back()); 1590 } 1591 1592 case LOLR_StringTemplate: { 1593 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 1594 1595 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy); 1596 bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 1597 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 1598 1599 TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy); 1600 TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy)); 1601 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo)); 1602 1603 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) { 1604 Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I); 1605 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy); 1606 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 1607 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 1608 } 1609 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(), 1610 &ExplicitArgs); 1611 } 1612 case LOLR_Raw: 1613 case LOLR_Template: 1614 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1615 case LOLR_Error: 1616 return ExprError(); 1617 } 1618 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1619 } 1620 1621 ExprResult 1622 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1623 SourceLocation Loc, 1624 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) { 1625 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc); 1626 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS); 1627 } 1628 1629 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a 1630 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture. 1631 ExprResult 1632 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1633 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1634 const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD, 1635 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1636 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 1637 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) 1638 if (const FunctionDecl *Callee = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 1639 CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller), 1640 CalleeTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee); 1641 if (CheckCUDATarget(CallerTarget, CalleeTarget)) { 1642 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_ref_bad_target) 1643 << CalleeTarget << D->getIdentifier() << CallerTarget; 1644 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 1645 << D->getIdentifier(); 1646 return ExprError(); 1647 } 1648 } 1649 1650 bool refersToEnclosingScope = 1651 (CurContext != D->getDeclContext() && 1652 D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) || 1653 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1654 cast<VarDecl>(D)->isInitCapture()); 1655 1656 DeclRefExpr *E; 1657 if (isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) { 1658 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 1659 cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D); 1660 1661 E = DeclRefExpr::Create( 1662 Context, 1663 SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 1664 VarSpec->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), D, refersToEnclosingScope, 1665 NameInfo.getLoc(), Ty, VK, FoundD, TemplateArgs); 1666 } else { 1667 assert(!TemplateArgs && "No template arguments for non-variable" 1668 " template specialization references"); 1669 E = DeclRefExpr::Create( 1670 Context, 1671 SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), 1672 SourceLocation(), D, refersToEnclosingScope, NameInfo, Ty, VK, FoundD); 1673 } 1674 1675 MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 1676 1677 if (getLangOpts().ObjCARCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1678 Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && 1679 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getLocStart())) 1680 recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(E); 1681 1682 // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member. 1683 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 1684 if (FD && FD->isBitField()) 1685 E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField); 1686 1687 return E; 1688 } 1689 1690 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and 1691 /// possibly a list of template arguments. 1692 /// 1693 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call 1694 /// DecomposeTemplateName. 1695 /// 1696 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for 1697 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in 1698 /// some way. 1699 void 1700 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id, 1701 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer, 1702 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1703 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) { 1704 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) { 1705 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 1706 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 1707 1708 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 1709 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs); 1710 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer); 1711 1712 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get(); 1713 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 1714 NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 1715 TemplateArgs = &Buffer; 1716 } else { 1717 NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id); 1718 TemplateArgs = nullptr; 1719 } 1720 } 1721 1722 /// Diagnose an empty lookup. 1723 /// 1724 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found 1725 bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 1726 CorrectionCandidateCallback &CCC, 1727 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1728 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 1729 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 1730 1731 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use; 1732 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 1733 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName || 1734 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName || 1735 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 1736 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use; 1737 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest; 1738 } 1739 1740 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an 1741 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the 1742 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a 1743 // dependent name. 1744 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isEmpty() && !CallsUndergoingInstantiation.empty()) 1745 ? CurContext : nullptr; 1746 while (DC) { 1747 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 1748 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 1749 1750 if (!R.empty()) { 1751 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup. 1752 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 1753 1754 // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points 1755 // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a 1756 // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check. 1757 bool isDefaultArgument = !ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && 1758 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.back().Kind == 1759 ActiveTemplateInstantiation::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation; 1760 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext); 1761 bool isInstance = CurMethod && 1762 CurMethod->isInstance() && 1763 DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument; 1764 1765 1766 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'. 1767 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases. 1768 // Actually quite difficult! 1769 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 1770 diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup; 1771 if (isInstance) { 1772 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name 1773 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->"); 1774 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>( 1775 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee()); 1776 1777 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod; 1778 if (CurMethod->isDependentContext()) 1779 DepMethod = CurMethod; 1780 else if (CurMethod->getTemplatedKind() == 1781 FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplateSpecialization) 1782 DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurMethod->getPrimaryTemplate()-> 1783 getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()); 1784 else 1785 DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>( 1786 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()); 1787 assert(DepMethod && "No template pattern found"); 1788 1789 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context); 1790 CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc()); 1791 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr( 1792 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false); 1793 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList; 1794 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) 1795 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList); 1796 1797 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1798 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc()); 1799 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr = 1800 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create( 1801 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(), 1802 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 1803 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), nullptr, 1804 R.getLookupNameInfo(), 1805 ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() ? &TList : nullptr); 1806 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr); 1807 } else { 1808 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1809 } 1810 1811 // Do we really want to note all of these? 1812 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) 1813 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use); 1814 1815 // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation 1816 // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise 1817 // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an 1818 // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument. 1819 if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) { 1820 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object); 1821 return true; 1822 } 1823 1824 // Tell the callee to try to recover. 1825 return false; 1826 } 1827 1828 R.clear(); 1829 } 1830 1831 // In Microsoft mode, if we are performing lookup from within a friend 1832 // function definition declared at class scope then we must set 1833 // DC to the lexical parent to be able to search into the parent 1834 // class. 1835 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) && 1836 cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)->getFriendObjectKind() && 1837 DC->getLexicalParent()->isRecord()) 1838 DC = DC->getLexicalParent(); 1839 else 1840 DC = DC->getParent(); 1841 } 1842 1843 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo. 1844 TypoCorrection Corrected; 1845 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), 1846 S, &SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery))) { 1847 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 1848 bool DroppedSpecifier = 1849 Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 1850 R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 1851 1852 bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false; 1853 bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false; 1854 NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl(); 1855 if (ND) { 1856 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 1857 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(), 1858 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 1859 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 1860 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(), 1861 CDEnd = Corrected.end(); 1862 CD != CDEnd; ++CD) { 1863 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = 1864 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*CD)) 1865 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 1866 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1867 Args, OCS); 1868 else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD)) 1869 if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0) 1870 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), 1871 Args, OCS); 1872 } 1873 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) { 1874 case OR_Success: 1875 ND = Best->Function; 1876 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 1877 break; 1878 default: 1879 // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note. 1880 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 1881 break; 1882 } 1883 } 1884 R.addDecl(ND); 1885 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) { 1886 CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 1887 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) { 1888 const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType(); 1889 Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 1890 } 1891 if (!Record) 1892 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>( 1893 ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()); 1894 R.setNamingClass(Record); 1895 } 1896 1897 AcceptableWithRecovery = 1898 isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND); 1899 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or 1900 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser 1901 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo 1902 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going 1903 // to recover well anyway. 1904 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = 1905 isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND); 1906 } else { 1907 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it 1908 // because we aren't able to recover. 1909 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true; 1910 } 1911 1912 if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) { 1913 unsigned NoteID = (Corrected.getCorrectionDecl() && 1914 isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(Corrected.getCorrectionDecl())) 1915 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 1916 : diag::note_previous_decl; 1917 if (SS.isEmpty()) 1918 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name, 1919 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 1920 else 1921 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 1922 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 1923 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(), 1924 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 1925 1926 // Tell the callee whether to try to recover. 1927 return !AcceptableWithRecovery; 1928 } 1929 } 1930 R.clear(); 1931 1932 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 1933 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 1934 if (!SS.isEmpty()) { 1935 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 1936 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 1937 << SS.getRange(); 1938 return true; 1939 } 1940 1941 // Give up, we can't recover. 1942 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1943 return true; 1944 } 1945 1946 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has 1947 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then 1948 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class. We can only 1949 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts 1950 /// where 'this' is available. This doesn't precisely match MSVC's 1951 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough. 1952 static Expr * 1953 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context, 1954 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1955 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 1956 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1957 // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or 1958 // contexts where 'this' is available. 1959 QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType(); 1960 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 1961 if (!ThisType.isNull()) 1962 RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 1963 else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext)) 1964 RD = MD->getParent(); 1965 if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases()) 1966 return nullptr; 1967 1968 // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class. If 'this' 1969 // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit. 1970 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 1971 auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base); 1972 DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD; 1973 1974 if (!ThisType.isNull()) { 1975 DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->"); 1976 return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create( 1977 Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true, 1978 /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc, 1979 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 1980 } 1981 1982 // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class. This will 1983 // perform name lookup during template instantiation. 1984 CXXScopeSpec SS; 1985 auto *NNS = 1986 NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl()); 1987 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc)); 1988 return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create( 1989 Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 1990 TemplateArgs); 1991 } 1992 1993 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, 1994 CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1995 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 1996 UnqualifiedId &Id, 1997 bool HasTrailingLParen, 1998 bool IsAddressOfOperand, 1999 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC, 2000 bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier) { 2001 assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) && 2002 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen"); 2003 if (SS.isInvalid()) 2004 return ExprError(); 2005 2006 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer; 2007 2008 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data. 2009 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 2010 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs; 2011 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2012 2013 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 2014 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 2015 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2016 2017 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3: 2018 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains: 2019 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type, 2020 // (note: handled after lookup) 2021 // -- a template-id that is dependent, 2022 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr) 2023 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type, 2024 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that 2025 // names a dependent type. 2026 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization; 2027 // we need to handle these differently. 2028 bool DependentID = false; 2029 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName && 2030 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) { 2031 DependentID = true; 2032 } else if (SS.isSet()) { 2033 if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) { 2034 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2035 return ExprError(); 2036 } else { 2037 DependentID = true; 2038 } 2039 } 2040 2041 if (DependentID) 2042 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2043 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2044 2045 // Perform the required lookup. 2046 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, 2047 (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam) 2048 ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam : LookupOrdinaryName); 2049 if (TemplateArgs) { 2050 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in 2051 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the 2052 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If 2053 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those 2054 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it. 2055 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 2056 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false, 2057 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization); 2058 2059 if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization || 2060 (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)) 2061 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2062 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2063 } else { 2064 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl(); 2065 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp); 2066 2067 // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent 2068 // id-expression. 2069 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2070 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2071 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2072 2073 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do 2074 // some special Objective-C lookup, too. 2075 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) { 2076 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true)); 2077 if (E.isInvalid()) 2078 return ExprError(); 2079 2080 if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>()) 2081 return Ex; 2082 } 2083 } 2084 2085 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2086 return ExprError(); 2087 2088 // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90, 2089 // extension in C99, forbidden in C++). 2090 if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2091 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S); 2092 if (D) R.addDecl(D); 2093 } 2094 2095 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for 2096 // argument-dependent lookup. 2097 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen); 2098 2099 if (R.empty() && !ADL) { 2100 if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 2101 if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo, 2102 TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs)) 2103 return E; 2104 } 2105 2106 // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly. 2107 if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier) 2108 return ExprError(); 2109 2110 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function 2111 // call, diagnose the problem. 2112 CorrectionCandidateCallback DefaultValidator; 2113 DefaultValidator.IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand; 2114 assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) && 2115 "Typo correction callback misconfigured"); 2116 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CCC ? *CCC : DefaultValidator)) 2117 return ExprError(); 2118 2119 assert(!R.empty() && 2120 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results"); 2121 2122 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 2123 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 2124 // reference the ivar. 2125 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 2126 R.clear(); 2127 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier())); 2128 // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable 2129 // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it. 2130 if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get()) 2131 return ExprError(); 2132 return E; 2133 } 2134 } 2135 2136 // This is guaranteed from this point on. 2137 assert(!R.empty() || ADL); 2138 2139 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access. 2140 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3: 2141 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access 2142 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the 2143 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup 2144 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type 2145 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a 2146 // class member access expression using (*this) as the 2147 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator. 2148 // 2149 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R 2150 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the 2151 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a 2152 // non-static member function: 2153 // 2154 // C++ [expr.ref]p4: 2155 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . . 2156 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a 2157 // member function call. 2158 // 2159 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important 2160 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a 2161 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent 2162 // instance method. 2163 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 2164 bool MightBeImplicitMember; 2165 if (!IsAddressOfOperand) 2166 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2167 else if (!SS.isEmpty()) 2168 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2169 else if (R.isOverloadedResult()) 2170 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2171 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult()) 2172 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2173 else 2174 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2175 isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2176 isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()); 2177 2178 if (MightBeImplicitMember) 2179 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, 2180 R, TemplateArgs); 2181 } 2182 2183 if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) { 2184 2185 // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it 2186 // in BuildTemplateIdExpr(). 2187 // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration. 2188 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId && 2189 Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) { 2190 assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() && 2191 "There should only be one declaration found."); 2192 } 2193 2194 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs); 2195 } 2196 2197 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL); 2198 } 2199 2200 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified 2201 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation. 2202 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along 2203 /// this path. 2204 ExprResult 2205 Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2206 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 2207 bool IsAddressOfOperand, 2208 TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) { 2209 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 2210 if (!DC) 2211 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2212 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2213 2214 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2215 return ExprError(); 2216 2217 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName); 2218 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 2219 2220 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2221 return ExprError(); 2222 2223 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2224 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2225 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2226 2227 if (R.empty()) { 2228 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 2229 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange(); 2230 return ExprError(); 2231 } 2232 2233 if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) { 2234 // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in 2235 // a dependent context. If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to 2236 // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode. 2237 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 2238 if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 2239 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 2240 SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc(); 2241 auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID); 2242 D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString() 2243 << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc()); 2244 2245 // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE 2246 // context. 2247 if (!RecoveryTSI) 2248 return ExprError(); 2249 2250 // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover. 2251 D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename "); 2252 2253 // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type. 2254 QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 2255 TypeLocBuilder TLB; 2256 TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc()); 2257 2258 QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty); 2259 ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET); 2260 QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 2261 QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 2262 2263 *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET); 2264 2265 return ExprEmpty(); 2266 } 2267 2268 // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually 2269 // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in 2270 // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming 2271 // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11. 2272 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand) 2273 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, 2274 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2275 R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2276 2277 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false); 2278 } 2279 2280 /// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has 2281 /// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some 2282 /// additional lookup. 2283 /// 2284 /// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's 2285 /// actually quite a lot of extra work involved. 2286 /// 2287 /// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success. 2288 ExprResult 2289 Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S, 2290 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2291 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc(); 2292 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 2293 2294 // Check for error condition which is already reported. 2295 if (!CurMethod) 2296 return ExprError(); 2297 2298 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed, 2299 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have 2300 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e. 2301 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with 2302 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl. 2303 2304 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for 2305 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an 2306 // ivar, that's an error. 2307 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod(); 2308 2309 bool LookForIvars; 2310 if (Lookup.empty()) 2311 LookForIvars = true; 2312 else if (IsClassMethod) 2313 LookForIvars = false; 2314 else 2315 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2316 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()); 2317 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 2318 if (LookForIvars) { 2319 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface(); 2320 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2321 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr; 2322 if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) { 2323 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method. 2324 if (IsClassMethod) 2325 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2326 << IV->getDeclName()); 2327 2328 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent 2329 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl. 2330 if (IV->isInvalidDecl()) 2331 return ExprError(); 2332 2333 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)). 2334 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc)) 2335 return ExprError(); 2336 2337 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class. 2338 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private && 2339 !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) && 2340 !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport) 2341 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2342 2343 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't 2344 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something. 2345 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self"); 2346 UnqualifiedId SelfName; 2347 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation()); 2348 SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam); 2349 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec; 2350 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 2351 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc, 2352 SelfName, false, false); 2353 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2354 return ExprError(); 2355 2356 SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get()); 2357 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2358 return ExprError(); 2359 2360 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true); 2361 2362 ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily(); 2363 if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize && 2364 !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV)) 2365 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2366 2367 ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), 2368 Loc, IV->getLocation(), 2369 SelfExpr.get(), 2370 true, true); 2371 2372 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 2373 if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) { 2374 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc)) 2375 recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(Result); 2376 } 2377 if (CurContext->isClosure()) 2378 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self) 2379 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "self->"); 2380 } 2381 2382 return Result; 2383 } 2384 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) { 2385 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar. 2386 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) { 2387 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2388 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) { 2389 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private || 2390 declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared)) 2391 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName(); 2392 } 2393 } 2394 } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2395 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) { 2396 // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error. 2397 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl())) 2398 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2399 << IV->getDeclName()); 2400 } 2401 2402 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2403 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName. 2404 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 2405 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2406 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) { 2407 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID, 2408 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(), 2409 Lookup.getNameLoc()); 2410 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D); 2411 } 2412 } 2413 } 2414 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special. 2415 return ExprResult((Expr *)nullptr); 2416 } 2417 2418 /// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type. 2419 /// 2420 /// Logically this happens in three phases: 2421 /// 2422 /// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class. 2423 /// The naming class is the class into which we were looking 2424 /// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a 2425 /// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type. 2426 /// 2427 /// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class. 2428 /// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by 2429 /// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's 2430 /// the class declaring the member. 2431 /// 2432 /// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true" 2433 /// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not 2434 /// obey access control. 2435 ExprResult 2436 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From, 2437 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 2438 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 2439 NamedDecl *Member) { 2440 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext()); 2441 if (!RD) 2442 return From; 2443 2444 QualType DestRecordType; 2445 QualType DestType; 2446 QualType FromRecordType; 2447 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2448 bool PointerConversions = false; 2449 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) { 2450 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD)); 2451 2452 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2453 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType); 2454 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2455 PointerConversions = true; 2456 } else { 2457 DestType = DestRecordType; 2458 FromRecordType = FromType; 2459 } 2460 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) { 2461 if (Method->isStatic()) 2462 return From; 2463 2464 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context); 2465 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType(); 2466 2467 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2468 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2469 PointerConversions = true; 2470 } else { 2471 FromRecordType = FromType; 2472 DestType = DestRecordType; 2473 } 2474 } else { 2475 // No conversion necessary. 2476 return From; 2477 } 2478 2479 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType()) 2480 return From; 2481 2482 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary. 2483 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2484 return From; 2485 2486 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange(); 2487 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin(); 2488 2489 ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind(); 2490 2491 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8: 2492 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its 2493 // class name. 2494 // 2495 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a 2496 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type 2497 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows 2498 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as: 2499 // 2500 // class Base { public: int x; }; 2501 // class Derived1 : public Base { }; 2502 // class Derived2 : public Base { }; 2503 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); }; 2504 // 2505 // void VeryDerived::f() { 2506 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects 2507 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1 2508 // } 2509 if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) { 2510 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0); 2511 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type"); 2512 2513 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0); 2514 2515 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base 2516 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it. 2517 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts. 2518 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) { 2519 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2520 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType, 2521 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2522 return ExprError(); 2523 2524 if (PointerConversions) 2525 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType); 2526 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2527 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2528 2529 FromType = QType; 2530 FromRecordType = QRecordType; 2531 2532 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type, 2533 // we're done. 2534 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2535 return From; 2536 } 2537 } 2538 2539 bool IgnoreAccess = false; 2540 2541 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast 2542 // down to the using declaration's type. 2543 // 2544 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a 2545 // class ever has member declarations. 2546 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) { 2547 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)); 2548 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType( 2549 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext())); 2550 2551 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class 2552 // conversion is non-trivial. 2553 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) { 2554 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType)); 2555 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2556 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType, 2557 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2558 return ExprError(); 2559 2560 QualType UType = URecordType; 2561 if (PointerConversions) 2562 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType); 2563 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2564 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2565 FromType = UType; 2566 FromRecordType = URecordType; 2567 } 2568 2569 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the 2570 // declaring class to the true declaring class. 2571 IgnoreAccess = true; 2572 } 2573 2574 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2575 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType, 2576 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath, 2577 IgnoreAccess)) 2578 return ExprError(); 2579 2580 return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2581 VK, &BasePath); 2582 } 2583 2584 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2585 const LookupResult &R, 2586 bool HasTrailingLParen) { 2587 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call. 2588 if (!HasTrailingLParen) 2589 return false; 2590 2591 // Never if a scope specifier was provided. 2592 if (SS.isSet()) 2593 return false; 2594 2595 // Only in C++ or ObjC++. 2596 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2597 return false; 2598 2599 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during 2600 // normal lookup: 2601 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) { 2602 NamedDecl *D = *I; 2603 2604 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2605 // -- a declaration of a class member 2606 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the 2607 // original decl. 2608 if (D->isCXXClassMember()) 2609 return false; 2610 2611 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2612 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 2613 // using-declaration 2614 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we 2615 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types 2616 // turn off ADL anyway). 2617 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 2618 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 2619 else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 2620 return false; 2621 2622 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2623 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 2624 // template 2625 // And also for builtin functions. 2626 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2627 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 2628 2629 // But also builtin functions. 2630 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit()) 2631 return false; 2632 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 2633 return false; 2634 } 2635 2636 return true; 2637 } 2638 2639 2640 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration 2641 /// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that 2642 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration 2643 /// will in fact be used. 2644 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) { 2645 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2646 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName(); 2647 return true; 2648 } 2649 2650 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 2651 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName(); 2652 return true; 2653 } 2654 2655 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) { 2656 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName(); 2657 return true; 2658 } 2659 2660 return false; 2661 } 2662 2663 ExprResult 2664 Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2665 LookupResult &R, 2666 bool NeedsADL) { 2667 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL, 2668 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref. 2669 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>()) 2670 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(), 2671 R.getRepresentativeDecl()); 2672 2673 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one 2674 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be 2675 // functions and function templates. 2676 if (R.isSingleResult() && 2677 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl())) 2678 return ExprError(); 2679 2680 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress 2681 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when 2682 // we've picked a target. 2683 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 2684 2685 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE 2686 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(), 2687 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 2688 R.getLookupNameInfo(), 2689 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(), 2690 R.begin(), R.end()); 2691 2692 return ULE; 2693 } 2694 2695 /// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration. 2696 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr( 2697 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D, 2698 NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 2699 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration"); 2700 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) && 2701 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template"); 2702 2703 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2704 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D)) 2705 return ExprError(); 2706 2707 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) { 2708 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing 2709 // a template argument list. 2710 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref) << (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(D) ? 1 : 0) 2711 << Template << SS.getRange(); 2712 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here); 2713 return ExprError(); 2714 } 2715 2716 // Make sure that we're referring to a value. 2717 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 2718 if (!VD) { 2719 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value) 2720 << D << SS.getRange(); 2721 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 2722 return ExprError(); 2723 } 2724 2725 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress 2726 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup 2727 // on this function name, because this might not be the function 2728 // that overload resolution actually selects. 2729 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc)) 2730 return ExprError(); 2731 2732 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's. 2733 if (VD->isInvalidDecl()) 2734 return ExprError(); 2735 2736 // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions. If we got here, 2737 // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this 2738 // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression. 2739 if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 2740 if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember()) 2741 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(), 2742 indirectField); 2743 2744 { 2745 QualType type = VD->getType(); 2746 ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue; 2747 2748 switch (D->getKind()) { 2749 // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds. 2750 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind) 2751 #define VALUE(type, base) 2752 #define DECL(type, base) \ 2753 case Decl::type: 2754 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc" 2755 llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind"); 2756 2757 // These shouldn't make it here. 2758 case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField: 2759 case Decl::ObjCIvar: 2760 llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?"); 2761 2762 // Enum constants are always r-values and never references. 2763 // Unresolved using declarations are dependent. 2764 case Decl::EnumConstant: 2765 case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue: 2766 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2767 break; 2768 2769 // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for 2770 // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for 2771 // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really 2772 // exist in the high-level semantics. 2773 case Decl::Field: 2774 case Decl::IndirectField: 2775 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2776 "building reference to field in C?"); 2777 2778 // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but 2779 // for internal consistency we do this anyway. 2780 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 2781 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2782 break; 2783 2784 // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values 2785 // depending on the type. 2786 case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: { 2787 if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 2788 type = reftype->getPointeeType(); 2789 valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference 2790 break; 2791 } 2792 2793 // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case 2794 // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever. 2795 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2796 type = type.getUnqualifiedType(); 2797 break; 2798 } 2799 2800 case Decl::Var: 2801 case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization: 2802 case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization: 2803 // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value. 2804 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2805 !type.hasQualifiers() && 2806 type->isVoidType()) { 2807 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2808 break; 2809 } 2810 // fallthrough 2811 2812 case Decl::ImplicitParam: 2813 case Decl::ParmVar: { 2814 // These are always l-values. 2815 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2816 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 2817 2818 // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in 2819 // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually 2820 // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no. 2821 if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) { 2822 QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc); 2823 if (!CapturedType.isNull()) 2824 type = CapturedType; 2825 } 2826 2827 break; 2828 } 2829 2830 case Decl::Function: { 2831 if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) { 2832 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) { 2833 type = Context.BuiltinFnTy; 2834 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2835 break; 2836 } 2837 } 2838 2839 const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>(); 2840 2841 // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype 2842 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 2843 if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 2844 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 2845 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2846 break; 2847 } 2848 2849 // Functions are l-values in C++. 2850 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2851 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2852 break; 2853 } 2854 2855 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a 2856 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only 2857 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing 2858 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function 2859 // type. 2860 if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() && 2861 isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty)) 2862 type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(), 2863 fty->getExtInfo()); 2864 2865 // Functions are r-values in C. 2866 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2867 break; 2868 } 2869 2870 case Decl::MSProperty: 2871 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2872 break; 2873 2874 case Decl::CXXMethod: 2875 // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype 2876 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 2877 // This should only be possible with a type written directly. 2878 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto 2879 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType())) 2880 if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 2881 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 2882 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2883 break; 2884 } 2885 2886 // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static. 2887 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) { 2888 valueKind = VK_LValue; 2889 break; 2890 } 2891 // fallthrough 2892 2893 case Decl::CXXConversion: 2894 case Decl::CXXDestructor: 2895 case Decl::CXXConstructor: 2896 valueKind = VK_RValue; 2897 break; 2898 } 2899 2900 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD, 2901 TemplateArgs); 2902 } 2903 } 2904 2905 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, 2906 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT) { 2907 // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function. 2908 Decl *currentDecl = nullptr; 2909 if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock()) 2910 currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl; 2911 else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) 2912 currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator; 2913 else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion()) 2914 currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl; 2915 else 2916 currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl(); 2917 2918 if (!currentDecl) { 2919 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function); 2920 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 2921 } 2922 2923 QualType ResTy; 2924 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) 2925 ResTy = Context.DependentTy; 2926 else { 2927 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of 2928 // the string. 2929 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length(); 2930 2931 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1); 2932 if (IT == PredefinedExpr::LFunction) 2933 ResTy = Context.WideCharTy.withConst(); 2934 else 2935 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst(); 2936 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0); 2937 } 2938 2939 return new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT); 2940 } 2941 2942 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 2943 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT; 2944 2945 switch (Kind) { 2946 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!"); 2947 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2] 2948 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break; 2949 case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS] 2950 case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS] 2951 case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break; 2952 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break; 2953 } 2954 2955 return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IT); 2956 } 2957 2958 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 2959 SmallString<16> CharBuffer; 2960 bool Invalid = false; 2961 StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid); 2962 if (Invalid) 2963 return ExprError(); 2964 2965 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(), 2966 PP, Tok.getKind()); 2967 if (Literal.hadError()) 2968 return ExprError(); 2969 2970 QualType Ty; 2971 if (Literal.isWide()) 2972 Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++. 2973 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 2974 Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11. 2975 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 2976 Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11. 2977 else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar()) 2978 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++. 2979 else 2980 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++ 2981 2982 CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii; 2983 if (Literal.isWide()) 2984 Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide; 2985 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 2986 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16; 2987 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 2988 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32; 2989 2990 Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty, 2991 Tok.getLocation()); 2992 2993 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 2994 return Lit; 2995 2996 // We're building a user-defined literal. 2997 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 2998 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 2999 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3000 3001 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3002 if (!UDLScope) 3003 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl)); 3004 3005 // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 3006 // operator "" X (ch) 3007 return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc, 3008 Lit, Tok.getLocation()); 3009 } 3010 3011 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) { 3012 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3013 return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val), 3014 Context.IntTy, Loc); 3015 } 3016 3017 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal, 3018 QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) { 3019 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty); 3020 3021 using llvm::APFloat; 3022 APFloat Val(Format); 3023 3024 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val); 3025 3026 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if 3027 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow). 3028 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) || 3029 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) { 3030 unsigned diagnostic; 3031 SmallString<20> buffer; 3032 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) { 3033 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow; 3034 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer); 3035 } else { 3036 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow; 3037 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer); 3038 } 3039 3040 S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic) 3041 << Ty 3042 << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size()); 3043 } 3044 3045 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK); 3046 return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc); 3047 } 3048 3049 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3050 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit 3051 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix. 3052 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) { 3053 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok); 3054 return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0'); 3055 } 3056 3057 SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer; 3058 // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character. Add padding to 3059 // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer. If getSpelling() 3060 // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at 3061 // the EOF, so it is also safe. 3062 SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1); 3063 3064 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc. 3065 bool Invalid = false; 3066 StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid); 3067 if (Invalid) 3068 return ExprError(); 3069 3070 NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP); 3071 if (Literal.hadError) 3072 return ExprError(); 3073 3074 if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) { 3075 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3076 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3077 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3078 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3079 3080 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3081 if (!UDLScope) 3082 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl)); 3083 3084 QualType CookedTy; 3085 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3086 // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3087 // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3088 // operator "" X (f L) 3089 CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3090 } else { 3091 // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3092 // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3093 // operator "" X (n ULL) 3094 CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3095 } 3096 3097 DeclarationName OpName = 3098 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 3099 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 3100 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 3101 3102 SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation(); 3103 3104 // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw 3105 // literal or a cooked one. 3106 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 3107 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy, 3108 /*AllowRaw*/true, /*AllowTemplate*/true, 3109 /*AllowStringTemplate*/false)) { 3110 case LOLR_Error: 3111 return ExprError(); 3112 3113 case LOLR_Cooked: { 3114 Expr *Lit; 3115 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3116 Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation()); 3117 } else { 3118 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0); 3119 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) 3120 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_too_large); 3121 Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy, 3122 Tok.getLocation()); 3123 } 3124 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3125 } 3126 3127 case LOLR_Raw: { 3128 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the 3129 // literal is treated as a call of the form 3130 // operator "" X ("n") 3131 unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); 3132 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType( 3133 Context.CharTy.withConst(), llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), 3134 ArrayType::Normal, 0); 3135 Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create( 3136 Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii, 3137 /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1); 3138 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3139 } 3140 3141 case LOLR_Template: { 3142 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator 3143 // template), L is treated as a call fo the form 3144 // operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>() 3145 // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck. 3146 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 3147 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy); 3148 bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 3149 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 3150 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) { 3151 Value = TokSpelling[I]; 3152 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy); 3153 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 3154 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 3155 } 3156 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc, 3157 &ExplicitArgs); 3158 } 3159 case LOLR_StringTemplate: 3160 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 3161 } 3162 } 3163 3164 Expr *Res; 3165 3166 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3167 QualType Ty; 3168 if (Literal.isFloat) 3169 Ty = Context.FloatTy; 3170 else if (!Literal.isLong) 3171 Ty = Context.DoubleTy; 3172 else 3173 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3174 3175 Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3176 3177 if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) { 3178 if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) { 3179 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3180 } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp64) { 3181 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64); 3182 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3183 } 3184 } 3185 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) { 3186 return ExprError(); 3187 } else { 3188 QualType Ty; 3189 3190 // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature. 3191 if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) { 3192 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3193 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), 3194 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 3195 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong); 3196 else 3197 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong); 3198 } 3199 3200 // Get the value in the widest-possible width. 3201 unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth(); 3202 // The microsoft literal suffix extensions support 128-bit literals, which 3203 // may be wider than [u]intmax_t. 3204 // FIXME: Actually, they don't. We seem to have accidentally invented the 3205 // i128 suffix. 3206 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 128 && MaxWidth < 128 && 3207 Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type()) 3208 MaxWidth = 128; 3209 llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0); 3210 3211 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) { 3212 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull. 3213 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_too_large); 3214 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3215 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() && 3216 "long long is not intmax_t?"); 3217 } else { 3218 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into 3219 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5. 3220 3221 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to 3222 // be an unsigned int. 3223 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10; 3224 3225 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can. 3226 unsigned Width = 0; 3227 3228 // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized. 3229 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) { 3230 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger > MaxWidth) { 3231 // If this target doesn't support __int128, error and force to ull. 3232 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_int128_unsupported); 3233 Width = MaxWidth; 3234 Ty = Context.getIntMaxType(); 3235 } else { 3236 Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger; 3237 Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width, 3238 /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned); 3239 } 3240 } 3241 3242 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3243 // Are int/unsigned possibilities? 3244 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3245 3246 // Does it fit in a unsigned int? 3247 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) { 3248 // Does it fit in a signed int? 3249 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0) 3250 Ty = Context.IntTy; 3251 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3252 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 3253 Width = IntSize; 3254 } 3255 } 3256 3257 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities? 3258 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3259 unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 3260 3261 // Does it fit in a unsigned long? 3262 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) { 3263 // Does it fit in a signed long? 3264 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0) 3265 Ty = Context.LongTy; 3266 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3267 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 3268 Width = LongSize; 3269 } 3270 } 3271 3272 // Check long long if needed. 3273 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3274 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3275 3276 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long? 3277 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) { 3278 // Does it fit in a signed long long? 3279 // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the 3280 // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode. 3281 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 || 3282 (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && Literal.isLongLong))) 3283 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 3284 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3285 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3286 Width = LongLongSize; 3287 } 3288 } 3289 3290 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that 3291 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix. 3292 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3293 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_too_large_for_signed); 3294 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3295 Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3296 } 3297 3298 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width) 3299 ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width); 3300 } 3301 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3302 } 3303 3304 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper. 3305 if (Literal.isImaginary) 3306 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res, 3307 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType())); 3308 3309 return Res; 3310 } 3311 3312 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) { 3313 assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr"); 3314 return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E); 3315 } 3316 3317 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3318 SourceLocation Loc, 3319 SourceRange ArgRange) { 3320 // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in 3321 // scalar or vector data type argument..." 3322 // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic 3323 // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void. 3324 if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) { 3325 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type) 3326 << T << ArgRange; 3327 return true; 3328 } 3329 3330 assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) && 3331 "Scalar types should always be complete"); 3332 return false; 3333 } 3334 3335 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3336 SourceLocation Loc, 3337 SourceRange ArgRange, 3338 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3339 // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++. 3340 if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus) 3341 return true; 3342 3343 // C99 6.5.3.4p1: 3344 if (T->isFunctionType() && 3345 (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf)) { 3346 // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension. 3347 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3348 << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3349 return false; 3350 } 3351 3352 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where 3353 // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k) 3354 if (T->isVoidType()) { 3355 unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type 3356 : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type; 3357 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3358 return false; 3359 } 3360 3361 return true; 3362 } 3363 3364 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T, 3365 SourceLocation Loc, 3366 SourceRange ArgRange, 3367 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3368 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the 3369 // runtime doesn't allow it. 3370 if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) { 3371 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface) 3372 << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf) 3373 << ArgRange; 3374 return true; 3375 } 3376 3377 return false; 3378 } 3379 3380 /// \brief Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed 3381 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is. 3382 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, 3383 Expr *E) { 3384 // Don't warn if the operation changed the type. 3385 if (T != E->getType()) 3386 return; 3387 3388 // Now look for array decays. 3389 ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 3390 if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay) 3391 return; 3392 3393 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange() 3394 << ICE->getType() 3395 << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(); 3396 } 3397 3398 /// \brief Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression 3399 /// and type traits. 3400 /// 3401 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand 3402 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify 3403 /// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template 3404 /// instantiation, etc. 3405 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E, 3406 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3407 QualType ExprTy = E->getType(); 3408 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3409 3410 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3411 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3412 E->getSourceRange()); 3413 3414 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3415 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3416 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3417 return false; 3418 3419 // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of 3420 // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to 3421 // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown 3422 // bound). 3423 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) { 3424 if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), 3425 Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()), 3426 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind, 3427 E->getSourceRange())) 3428 return true; 3429 } else { 3430 if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3431 ExprKind, E->getSourceRange())) 3432 return true; 3433 } 3434 3435 // Completing the expression's type may have changed it. 3436 ExprTy = E->getType(); 3437 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3438 3439 if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) { 3440 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3441 << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange(); 3442 return true; 3443 } 3444 3445 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3446 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3447 return true; 3448 3449 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) { 3450 if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3451 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) { 3452 QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType(); 3453 QualType Type = PVD->getType(); 3454 if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) { 3455 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param) 3456 << Type << OType; 3457 Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 3458 } 3459 } 3460 } 3461 3462 // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array 3463 // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most 3464 // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x". 3465 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3466 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3467 BO->getLHS()); 3468 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3469 BO->getRHS()); 3470 } 3471 } 3472 3473 return false; 3474 } 3475 3476 /// \brief Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type 3477 /// traits. 3478 /// 3479 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints 3480 /// on those operands. 3481 /// 3482 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine. 3483 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state: 3484 /// Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ... 3485 /// 3486 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4 3487 /// The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer 3488 /// standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof. 3489 /// 3490 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions. 3491 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType, 3492 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3493 SourceRange ExprRange, 3494 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3495 if (ExprType->isDependentType()) 3496 return false; 3497 3498 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: 3499 // When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result 3500 // is the size of the referenced type. 3501 // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3502 // When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result 3503 // shall be the alignment of the referenced type. 3504 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 3505 ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType(); 3506 3507 // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3508 // When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result 3509 // is the alignment of the element type. 3510 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) 3511 ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType); 3512 3513 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3514 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange); 3515 3516 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3517 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3518 ExprKind)) 3519 return false; 3520 3521 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType, 3522 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3523 ExprKind, ExprRange)) 3524 return true; 3525 3526 if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) { 3527 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3528 << ExprKind << ExprRange; 3529 return true; 3530 } 3531 3532 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3533 ExprKind)) 3534 return true; 3535 3536 return false; 3537 } 3538 3539 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 3540 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3541 3542 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3543 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3544 return false; 3545 3546 if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { 3547 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) 3548 << 1 << E->getSourceRange(); 3549 return true; 3550 } 3551 3552 ValueDecl *D = nullptr; 3553 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 3554 D = DRE->getDecl(); 3555 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 3556 D = ME->getMemberDecl(); 3557 } 3558 3559 // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a 3560 // complete definition so that we can compute the layout. 3561 // 3562 // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member 3563 // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression 3564 // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member 3565 // in a trailing-return-type. 3566 // 3567 // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC 3568 // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the 3569 // nonsensical answer 0. 3570 // 3571 // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just 3572 // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing 3573 // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of 3574 // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal 3575 // use-case. 3576 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) { 3577 // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a 3578 // definition if we can find a member of it. 3579 if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) { 3580 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type) 3581 << E->getSourceRange(); 3582 return true; 3583 } 3584 3585 // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have 3586 // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a 3587 // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to 3588 // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial. 3589 if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 3590 return false; 3591 } 3592 3593 return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_AlignOf); 3594 } 3595 3596 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) { 3597 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3598 3599 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3600 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3601 return false; 3602 3603 return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep); 3604 } 3605 3606 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand. 3607 ExprResult 3608 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 3609 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3610 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, 3611 SourceRange R) { 3612 if (!TInfo) 3613 return ExprError(); 3614 3615 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 3616 3617 if (!T->isDependentType() && 3618 CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind)) 3619 return ExprError(); 3620 3621 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 3622 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 3623 ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd()); 3624 } 3625 3626 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression 3627 /// operand. 3628 ExprResult 3629 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc, 3630 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3631 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 3632 if (PE.isInvalid()) 3633 return ExprError(); 3634 3635 E = PE.get(); 3636 3637 // Verify that the operand is valid. 3638 bool isInvalid = false; 3639 if (E->isTypeDependent()) { 3640 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions. 3641 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) { 3642 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E); 3643 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) { 3644 isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E); 3645 } else if (E->refersToBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1. 3646 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0; 3647 isInvalid = true; 3648 } else { 3649 isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf); 3650 } 3651 3652 if (isInvalid) 3653 return ExprError(); 3654 3655 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) { 3656 PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 3657 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3658 E = PE.get(); 3659 } 3660 3661 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 3662 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 3663 ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 3664 } 3665 3666 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c 3667 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof 3668 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false. 3669 ExprResult 3670 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, 3671 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType, 3672 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) { 3673 // If error parsing type, ignore. 3674 if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError(); 3675 3676 if (IsType) { 3677 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 3678 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo); 3679 return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange); 3680 } 3681 3682 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx; 3683 ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind); 3684 return Result; 3685 } 3686 3687 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc, 3688 bool IsReal) { 3689 if (V.get()->isTypeDependent()) 3690 return S.Context.DependentTy; 3691 3692 // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values. 3693 if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) { 3694 V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get()); 3695 if (V.isInvalid()) 3696 return QualType(); 3697 } 3698 3699 // These operators return the element type of a complex type. 3700 if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>()) 3701 return CT->getElementType(); 3702 3703 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here. 3704 if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType()) 3705 return V.get()->getType(); 3706 3707 // Test for placeholders. 3708 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get()); 3709 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 3710 if (PR.get() != V.get()) { 3711 V = PR; 3712 return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal); 3713 } 3714 3715 // Reject anything else. 3716 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType() 3717 << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag"); 3718 return QualType(); 3719 } 3720 3721 3722 3723 ExprResult 3724 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 3725 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) { 3726 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 3727 switch (Kind) { 3728 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 3729 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break; 3730 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break; 3731 } 3732 3733 // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 3734 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input); 3735 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3736 Input = Result.get(); 3737 3738 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 3739 } 3740 3741 /// \brief Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal. 3742 /// 3743 /// \return true on error 3744 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S, 3745 SourceLocation opLoc, 3746 Expr *op) { 3747 assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()); 3748 if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() && 3749 !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime) 3750 return false; 3751 3752 S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface) 3753 << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType() 3754 << op->getSourceRange(); 3755 return true; 3756 } 3757 3758 ExprResult 3759 Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc, 3760 Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) { 3761 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 3762 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) { 3763 ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base); 3764 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3765 base = result.get(); 3766 } 3767 3768 // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index 3769 // expressions. We can't handle overloads here because the other 3770 // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload 3771 // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack 3772 // at the overload. 3773 if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 3774 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base); 3775 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3776 base = result.get(); 3777 } 3778 if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 3779 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx); 3780 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 3781 idx = result.get(); 3782 } 3783 3784 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent. 3785 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3786 (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) { 3787 return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy, 3788 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc); 3789 } 3790 3791 // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record 3792 // type. The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*, 3793 // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion 3794 // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution 3795 // to do if there aren't any record types involved. 3796 // 3797 // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied 3798 // to overload resolution and so should not take this path. 3799 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3800 (base->getType()->isRecordType() || 3801 (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 3802 idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) { 3803 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx); 3804 } 3805 3806 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc); 3807 } 3808 3809 ExprResult 3810 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc, 3811 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) { 3812 Expr *LHSExp = Base; 3813 Expr *RHSExp = Idx; 3814 3815 // Perform default conversions. 3816 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) { 3817 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp); 3818 if (Result.isInvalid()) 3819 return ExprError(); 3820 LHSExp = Result.get(); 3821 } 3822 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp); 3823 if (Result.isInvalid()) 3824 return ExprError(); 3825 RHSExp = Result.get(); 3826 3827 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 3828 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue; 3829 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 3830 3831 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent 3832 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be 3833 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base 3834 // and index from the expression types. 3835 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr; 3836 QualType ResultType; 3837 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) { 3838 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3839 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3840 ResultType = Context.DependentTy; 3841 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3842 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3843 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3844 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 3845 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 3846 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3847 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3848 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3849 3850 // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript 3851 // expression. 3852 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) 3853 return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr, 3854 nullptr); 3855 3856 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 3857 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 3858 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 3859 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 3860 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 3861 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 3862 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 3863 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 3864 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 3865 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 3866 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 3867 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 3868 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) { 3869 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface) 3870 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 3871 return ExprError(); 3872 } 3873 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 3874 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123] 3875 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3876 VK = LHSExp->getValueKind(); 3877 if (VK != VK_RValue) 3878 OK = OK_VectorComponent; 3879 3880 // FIXME: need to deal with const... 3881 ResultType = VTy->getElementType(); 3882 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) { 3883 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by 3884 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that 3885 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't 3886 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then 3887 // force the promotion here. 3888 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) << 3889 LHSExp->getSourceRange(); 3890 LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy), 3891 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 3892 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(); 3893 3894 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 3895 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 3896 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 3897 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) { 3898 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case 3899 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) << 3900 RHSExp->getSourceRange(); 3901 RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy), 3902 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 3903 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 3904 3905 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 3906 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 3907 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 3908 } else { 3909 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value) 3910 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange()); 3911 } 3912 // C99 6.5.2.1p1 3913 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 3914 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 3915 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange()); 3916 3917 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 3918 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 3919 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 3920 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange(); 3921 3922 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly, 3923 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object 3924 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance) 3925 // incomplete types are not object types. 3926 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) { 3927 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type) 3928 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 3929 return ExprError(); 3930 } 3931 3932 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3933 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void 3934 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type) 3935 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 3936 3937 // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values. 3938 // See IsCForbiddenLValueType. 3939 if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue; 3940 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && 3941 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType, 3942 diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr)) 3943 return ExprError(); 3944 3945 assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus || 3946 !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType()); 3947 3948 return new (Context) 3949 ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc); 3950 } 3951 3952 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, 3953 FunctionDecl *FD, 3954 ParmVarDecl *Param) { 3955 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) { 3956 Diag(CallLoc, 3957 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) << 3958 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName(); 3959 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param], 3960 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here); 3961 return ExprError(); 3962 } 3963 3964 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) { 3965 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg(); 3966 3967 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(*this, PotentiallyEvaluated, 3968 Param); 3969 3970 // Instantiate the expression. 3971 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList 3972 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true); 3973 3974 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, 3975 MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost()); 3976 if (Inst.isInvalid()) 3977 return ExprError(); 3978 3979 ExprResult Result; 3980 { 3981 // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5: 3982 // The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and 3983 // the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the 3984 // default argument expression appears. 3985 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD); 3986 LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this); 3987 Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList); 3988 } 3989 if (Result.isInvalid()) 3990 return ExprError(); 3991 3992 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter. 3993 InitializedEntity Entity 3994 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param); 3995 InitializationKind Kind 3996 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(), 3997 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getLocStart()); 3998 Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 3999 4000 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4001 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4002 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4003 return ExprError(); 4004 4005 Expr *Arg = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 4006 CheckCompletedExpr(Arg, Param->getOuterLocStart()); 4007 // Build the default argument expression. 4008 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param, Arg); 4009 } 4010 4011 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to 4012 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll 4013 // be properly destroyed. 4014 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new 4015 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810. 4016 // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because 4017 // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything. 4018 if (isa<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) { 4019 // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are 4020 // any explicit objects. 4021 ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 4022 4023 // Append all the objects to the cleanup list. Right now, this 4024 // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument 4025 // expressions should never be able to capture anything. 4026 assert(!cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())->getNumObjects() && 4027 "default argument expression has capturing blocks?"); 4028 } 4029 4030 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works. 4031 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression 4032 // as being "referenced". 4033 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(), 4034 /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true); 4035 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param); 4036 } 4037 4038 4039 Sema::VariadicCallType 4040 Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4041 Expr *Fn) { 4042 if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) { 4043 if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl)) 4044 return VariadicConstructor; 4045 else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) 4046 return VariadicBlock; 4047 else if (FDecl) { 4048 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 4049 if (Method->isInstance()) 4050 return VariadicMethod; 4051 } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) 4052 return VariadicMethod; 4053 return VariadicFunction; 4054 } 4055 return VariadicDoesNotApply; 4056 } 4057 4058 namespace { 4059 class FunctionCallCCC : public FunctionCallFilterCCC { 4060 public: 4061 FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName, 4062 unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME) 4063 : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME), 4064 FunctionName(FuncName) {} 4065 4066 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 4067 if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() || 4068 candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) { 4069 return false; 4070 } 4071 4072 return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate); 4073 } 4074 4075 private: 4076 const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName; 4077 }; 4078 } 4079 4080 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn, 4081 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4082 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 4083 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn); 4084 DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName(); 4085 SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getLocStart(); 4086 FunctionCallCCC CCC(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(), Args.size(), ME); 4087 4088 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo( 4089 DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 4090 S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr, CCC, 4091 Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 4092 if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) { 4093 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 4094 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 4095 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4096 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(), 4097 CDEnd = Corrected.end(); 4098 CD != CDEnd; ++CD) { 4099 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD)) 4100 S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args, 4101 OCS); 4102 } 4103 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) { 4104 case OR_Success: 4105 ND = Best->Function; 4106 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 4107 break; 4108 default: 4109 break; 4110 } 4111 } 4112 if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) { 4113 return Corrected; 4114 } 4115 } 4116 } 4117 return TypoCorrection(); 4118 } 4119 4120 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in 4121 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with 4122 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and 4123 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this 4124 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns 4125 /// true if the call is ill-formed. 4126 bool 4127 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn, 4128 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4129 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4130 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4131 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4132 bool IsExecConfig) { 4133 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 4134 // We don't need to do this in the 4135 if (FDecl) 4136 if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID()) 4137 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID)) 4138 return false; 4139 4140 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by 4141 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ... 4142 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 4143 bool Invalid = false; 4144 unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams; 4145 unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() 4146 ? 1 /* block */ 4147 : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */ 4148 : 0 /* function */); 4149 4150 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default 4151 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call. 4152 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 4153 if (Args.size() < MinArgs) { 4154 TypoCorrection TC; 4155 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 4156 unsigned diag_id = 4157 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4158 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest 4159 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest; 4160 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs 4161 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4162 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 4163 } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 4164 Diag(RParenLoc, 4165 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4166 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one 4167 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one) 4168 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4169 else 4170 Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4171 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args 4172 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least) 4173 << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4174 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4175 4176 // Emit the location of the prototype. 4177 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 4178 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl) 4179 << FDecl; 4180 4181 return true; 4182 } 4183 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams); 4184 } 4185 4186 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop 4187 // them. 4188 if (Args.size() > NumParams) { 4189 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) { 4190 TypoCorrection TC; 4191 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 4192 unsigned diag_id = 4193 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 4194 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest 4195 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest; 4196 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams 4197 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4198 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 4199 } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl && 4200 FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 4201 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4202 MinArgs == NumParams 4203 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one 4204 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one) 4205 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) 4206 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange() 4207 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4208 Args.back()->getLocEnd()); 4209 else 4210 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4211 MinArgs == NumParams 4212 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args 4213 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most) 4214 << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 4215 << Fn->getSourceRange() 4216 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(), 4217 Args.back()->getLocEnd()); 4218 4219 // Emit the location of the prototype. 4220 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 4221 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl) 4222 << FDecl; 4223 4224 // This deletes the extra arguments. 4225 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams); 4226 return true; 4227 } 4228 } 4229 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs; 4230 VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn); 4231 4232 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getLocStart(), FDecl, 4233 Proto, 0, Args, AllArgs, CallType); 4234 if (Invalid) 4235 return true; 4236 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size(); 4237 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i) 4238 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]); 4239 4240 return false; 4241 } 4242 4243 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4244 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4245 unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4246 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs, 4247 VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit, 4248 bool IsListInitialization) { 4249 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 4250 bool Invalid = false; 4251 unsigned ArgIx = 0; 4252 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args). 4253 for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) { 4254 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i); 4255 4256 Expr *Arg; 4257 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr; 4258 if (ArgIx < Args.size()) { 4259 Arg = Args[ArgIx++]; 4260 4261 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(), 4262 ProtoArgType, 4263 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 4264 return true; 4265 4266 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 4267 bool CFAudited = false; 4268 if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy && 4269 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 4270 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 4271 Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg); 4272 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 4273 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 4274 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 4275 CFAudited = true; 4276 4277 InitializedEntity Entity = 4278 Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param, 4279 ProtoArgType) 4280 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 4281 Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 4282 4283 // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API. 4284 if (CFAudited) 4285 Entity.setParameterCFAudited(); 4286 4287 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization( 4288 Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit); 4289 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 4290 return true; 4291 4292 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 4293 } else { 4294 assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee"); 4295 4296 ExprResult ArgExpr = 4297 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param); 4298 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid()) 4299 return true; 4300 4301 Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>(); 4302 } 4303 4304 // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This 4305 // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr 4306 // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator. 4307 CheckArrayAccess(Arg); 4308 4309 // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7). 4310 CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg); 4311 4312 AllArgs.push_back(Arg); 4313 } 4314 4315 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 4316 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) { 4317 // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that 4318 // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic. 4319 if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl && 4320 FDecl->isExternC()) { 4321 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) { 4322 QualType paramType; // ignored 4323 ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, Args[i], paramType); 4324 Invalid |= arg.isInvalid(); 4325 AllArgs.push_back(arg.get()); 4326 } 4327 4328 // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 4329 } else { 4330 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) { 4331 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], CallType, 4332 FDecl); 4333 Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid(); 4334 AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get()); 4335 } 4336 } 4337 4338 // Check for array bounds violations. 4339 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) 4340 CheckArrayAccess(Args[i]); 4341 } 4342 return Invalid; 4343 } 4344 4345 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) { 4346 TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 4347 if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>()) 4348 TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc(); 4349 if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>()) 4350 S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array) 4351 << ATL.getLocalSourceRange(); 4352 } 4353 4354 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static 4355 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by 4356 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large. 4357 /// 4358 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the 4359 /// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the 4360 /// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of 4361 /// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression. 4362 void 4363 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc, 4364 ParmVarDecl *Param, 4365 const Expr *ArgExpr) { 4366 // Static array parameters are not supported in C++. 4367 if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 4368 return; 4369 4370 QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType(); 4371 4372 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy); 4373 if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static) 4374 return; 4375 4376 if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 4377 Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) { 4378 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange(); 4379 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 4380 return; 4381 } 4382 4383 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT); 4384 if (!CAT) 4385 return; 4386 4387 const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT = 4388 Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()); 4389 if (!ArgCAT) 4390 return; 4391 4392 if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) { 4393 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small) 4394 << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() 4395 << (unsigned) ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue() 4396 << (unsigned) CAT->getSize().getZExtValue(); 4397 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 4398 } 4399 } 4400 4401 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 4402 /// to have a function type. 4403 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn); 4404 4405 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out 4406 /// immediately during argument processing? 4407 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) { 4408 // Placeholders are never sugared. 4409 const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type); 4410 if (!placeholder) return false; 4411 4412 switch (placeholder->getKind()) { 4413 // Ignore all the non-placeholder types. 4414 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) 4415 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID: 4416 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 4417 return false; 4418 4419 // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved 4420 // by the call machinery. 4421 case BuiltinType::Overload: 4422 return false; 4423 4424 // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and 4425 // should be left in place. 4426 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: 4427 return false; 4428 4429 // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible. 4430 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 4431 return true; 4432 4433 // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try 4434 // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types. 4435 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 4436 return true; 4437 4438 // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported. 4439 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: 4440 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: 4441 return true; 4442 } 4443 llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind"); 4444 } 4445 4446 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to 4447 /// handle later. 4448 static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) { 4449 // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of 4450 // dying at the first failure. 4451 bool hasInvalid = false; 4452 for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) { 4453 if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) { 4454 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]); 4455 if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true; 4456 else args[i] = result.get(); 4457 } 4458 } 4459 return hasInvalid; 4460 } 4461 4462 /// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments. 4463 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma 4464 /// locations. 4465 ExprResult 4466 Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 4467 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4468 Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) { 4469 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 4470 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn); 4471 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4472 Fn = Result.get(); 4473 4474 if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs)) 4475 return ExprError(); 4476 4477 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4478 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately. 4479 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) { 4480 if (!ArgExprs.empty()) { 4481 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments. 4482 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args) 4483 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 4484 SourceRange(ArgExprs[0]->getLocStart(), 4485 ArgExprs.back()->getLocEnd())); 4486 } 4487 4488 return new (Context) 4489 CallExpr(Context, Fn, None, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4490 } 4491 if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) { 4492 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn); 4493 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4494 Fn = result.get(); 4495 } 4496 4497 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template, 4498 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now. 4499 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in 4500 // Fn. 4501 bool Dependent = false; 4502 if (Fn->isTypeDependent()) 4503 Dependent = true; 4504 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) 4505 Dependent = true; 4506 4507 if (Dependent) { 4508 if (ExecConfig) { 4509 return new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr( 4510 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs, 4511 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4512 } else { 4513 return new (Context) CallExpr( 4514 Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4515 } 4516 } 4517 4518 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]). 4519 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType()) 4520 return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 4521 RParenLoc); 4522 4523 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 4524 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 4525 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4526 Fn = result.get(); 4527 } 4528 4529 if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) { 4530 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc); 4531 } 4532 } 4533 4534 // Check for overloaded calls. This can happen even in C due to extensions. 4535 if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) { 4536 OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn); 4537 4538 // We aren't supposed to apply this logic for if there's an '&' involved. 4539 if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) { 4540 OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression; 4541 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) { 4542 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl); 4543 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 4544 RParenLoc, ExecConfig); 4545 } else { 4546 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 4547 RParenLoc); 4548 } 4549 } 4550 } 4551 4552 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration. 4553 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 4554 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 4555 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4556 Fn = result.get(); 4557 } 4558 4559 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens(); 4560 4561 NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr; 4562 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn)) 4563 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) 4564 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 4565 4566 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) 4567 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl(); 4568 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) 4569 NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl(); 4570 4571 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) { 4572 if (FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>()) { 4573 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(FD, ArgExprs, true)) { 4574 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), 4575 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) ? 4576 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call : 4577 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 4578 << FD << FD->getSourceRange(); 4579 Diag(FD->getLocation(), 4580 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) 4581 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 4582 } 4583 } 4584 } 4585 4586 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, 4587 ExecConfig, IsExecConfig); 4588 } 4589 4590 ExprResult 4591 Sema::ActOnCUDAExecConfigExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LLLLoc, 4592 MultiExprArg ExecConfig, SourceLocation GGGLoc) { 4593 FunctionDecl *ConfigDecl = Context.getcudaConfigureCallDecl(); 4594 if (!ConfigDecl) 4595 return ExprError(Diag(LLLLoc, diag::err_undeclared_var_use) 4596 << "cudaConfigureCall"); 4597 QualType ConfigQTy = ConfigDecl->getType(); 4598 4599 DeclRefExpr *ConfigDR = new (Context) DeclRefExpr( 4600 ConfigDecl, false, ConfigQTy, VK_LValue, LLLLoc); 4601 MarkFunctionReferenced(LLLLoc, ConfigDecl); 4602 4603 return ActOnCallExpr(S, ConfigDR, LLLLoc, ExecConfig, GGGLoc, nullptr, 4604 /*IsExecConfig=*/true); 4605 } 4606 4607 /// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments. 4608 /// 4609 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type ) 4610 /// 4611 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 4612 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 4613 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 4614 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 4615 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 4616 QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy); 4617 QualType SrcTy = E->getType(); 4618 if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy)) 4619 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, 4620 diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size) 4621 << DstTy 4622 << SrcTy 4623 << E->getSourceRange()); 4624 return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 4625 } 4626 4627 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the 4628 /// provided arguments. 4629 /// 4630 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type ) 4631 /// 4632 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 4633 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 4634 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 4635 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4636 GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo); 4637 return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 4638 } 4639 4640 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression, 4641 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should 4642 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or 4643 /// block-pointer type. 4644 /// 4645 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available 4646 ExprResult 4647 Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl, 4648 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 4649 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 4650 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 4651 Expr *Config, bool IsExecConfig) { 4652 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 4653 unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0); 4654 4655 // Promote the function operand. 4656 // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting 4657 // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call. 4658 ExprResult Result; 4659 if (BuiltinID && 4660 Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) { 4661 Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType()), 4662 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get(); 4663 } else { 4664 Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn); 4665 } 4666 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4667 return ExprError(); 4668 Fn = Result.get(); 4669 4670 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup 4671 // of arguments and function on error. 4672 CallExpr *TheCall; 4673 if (Config) 4674 TheCall = new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(Context, Fn, 4675 cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args, 4676 Context.BoolTy, VK_RValue, 4677 RParenLoc); 4678 else 4679 TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, Context.BoolTy, 4680 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 4681 4682 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 4683 if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) 4684 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall); 4685 4686 retry: 4687 const FunctionType *FuncT; 4688 if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4689 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall 4690 // have type pointer to function". 4691 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 4692 if (!FuncT) 4693 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 4694 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4695 } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT = 4696 Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 4697 FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 4698 } else { 4699 // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type. 4700 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 4701 ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 4702 if (rewrite.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4703 Fn = rewrite.get(); 4704 TheCall->setCallee(Fn); 4705 goto retry; 4706 } 4707 4708 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 4709 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4710 } 4711 4712 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 4713 if (Config) { 4714 // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions 4715 if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 4716 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function) 4717 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4718 4719 // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type 4720 if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) 4721 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return) 4722 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4723 } else { 4724 // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured 4725 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 4726 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config) 4727 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4728 } 4729 } 4730 4731 // Check for a valid return type 4732 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getLocStart(), TheCall, 4733 FDecl)) 4734 return ExprError(); 4735 4736 // We know the result type of the call, set it. 4737 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context)); 4738 TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType())); 4739 4740 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT); 4741 if (Proto) { 4742 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc, 4743 IsExecConfig)) 4744 return ExprError(); 4745 } else { 4746 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!"); 4747 4748 if (FDecl) { 4749 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based 4750 // on our knowledge of the function definition. 4751 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 4752 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) { 4753 Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4754 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size())) 4755 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments) 4756 << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange(); 4757 } 4758 4759 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have 4760 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype. 4761 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype()) 4762 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 4763 } 4764 4765 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6). 4766 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) { 4767 Expr *Arg = Args[i]; 4768 4769 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) { 4770 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 4771 Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 4772 ExprResult ArgE = 4773 PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg); 4774 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 4775 return true; 4776 4777 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 4778 4779 } else { 4780 ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg); 4781 4782 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 4783 return true; 4784 4785 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 4786 } 4787 4788 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(), 4789 Arg->getType(), 4790 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 4791 return ExprError(); 4792 4793 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg); 4794 } 4795 } 4796 4797 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 4798 if (!Method->isStatic()) 4799 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) 4800 << Fn->getSourceRange()); 4801 4802 // Check for sentinels 4803 if (NDecl) 4804 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args); 4805 4806 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions. 4807 if (FDecl) { 4808 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 4809 return ExprError(); 4810 4811 if (BuiltinID) 4812 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall); 4813 } else if (NDecl) { 4814 if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 4815 return ExprError(); 4816 } else { 4817 if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto)) 4818 return ExprError(); 4819 } 4820 4821 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 4822 } 4823 4824 ExprResult 4825 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty, 4826 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) { 4827 assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type"); 4828 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out. 4829 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression"); 4830 4831 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4832 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 4833 if (!TInfo) 4834 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType); 4835 4836 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr); 4837 } 4838 4839 ExprResult 4840 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 4841 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) { 4842 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType(); 4843 4844 if (literalType->isArrayType()) { 4845 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType), 4846 diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type, 4847 SourceRange(LParenLoc, 4848 LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 4849 return ExprError(); 4850 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType()) 4851 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init) 4852 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())); 4853 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() && 4854 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType, 4855 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type, 4856 SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 4857 return ExprError(); 4858 4859 InitializedEntity Entity 4860 = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo); 4861 InitializationKind Kind 4862 = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc, 4863 SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), 4864 /*InitList=*/true); 4865 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr); 4866 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr, 4867 &literalType); 4868 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4869 return ExprError(); 4870 LiteralExpr = Result.get(); 4871 4872 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == nullptr; 4873 if (isFileScope && 4874 !LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() && 4875 !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() && 4876 !literalType->isDependentType()) { // 6.5.2.5p3 4877 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType)) 4878 return ExprError(); 4879 } 4880 4881 // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason. 4882 ExprValueKind VK = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue; 4883 4884 return MaybeBindToTemporary( 4885 new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType, 4886 VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope)); 4887 } 4888 4889 ExprResult 4890 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList, 4891 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) { 4892 // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders. Overloads can be 4893 // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't. 4894 for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) { 4895 if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4896 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]); 4897 4898 // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because 4899 // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc. 4900 if (result.isInvalid()) continue; 4901 4902 InitArgList[I] = result.get(); 4903 } 4904 } 4905 4906 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and 4907 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized. 4908 4909 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList, 4910 RBraceLoc); 4911 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now. 4912 return E; 4913 } 4914 4915 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC. 4916 static void maybeExtendBlockObject(Sema &S, ExprResult &E) { 4917 assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType()); 4918 assert(E.get()->isRValue()); 4919 4920 // Only do this in an r-value context. 4921 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return; 4922 4923 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(S.Context, E.get()->getType(), 4924 CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(), 4925 /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue); 4926 S.ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 4927 } 4928 4929 /// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object 4930 /// pointer type. 4931 CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) { 4932 QualType type = E.get()->getType(); 4933 if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 4934 return CK_BitCast; 4935 } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) { 4936 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, E); 4937 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 4938 } else { 4939 assert(type->isPointerType()); 4940 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 4941 } 4942 } 4943 4944 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages 4945 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required. 4946 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) { 4947 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer. 4948 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with 4949 // pointers. Everything else should be possible. 4950 4951 QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType(); 4952 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy)) 4953 return CK_NoOp; 4954 4955 switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 4956 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 4957 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 4958 4959 case Type::STK_CPointer: 4960 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 4961 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 4962 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 4963 case Type::STK_CPointer: { 4964 unsigned SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 4965 unsigned DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 4966 if (SrcAS != DestAS) 4967 return CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 4968 return CK_BitCast; 4969 } 4970 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 4971 return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer 4972 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 4973 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 4974 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer) 4975 return CK_BitCast; 4976 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer) 4977 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 4978 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, Src); 4979 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 4980 case Type::STK_Bool: 4981 return CK_PointerToBoolean; 4982 case Type::STK_Integral: 4983 return CK_PointerToIntegral; 4984 case Type::STK_Floating: 4985 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 4986 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 4987 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 4988 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer"); 4989 } 4990 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 4991 4992 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer 4993 case Type::STK_Integral: 4994 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 4995 case Type::STK_CPointer: 4996 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 4997 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 4998 if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 4999 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 5000 return CK_NullToPointer; 5001 return CK_IntegralToPointer; 5002 case Type::STK_Bool: 5003 return CK_IntegralToBoolean; 5004 case Type::STK_Integral: 5005 return CK_IntegralCast; 5006 case Type::STK_Floating: 5007 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 5008 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5009 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5010 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5011 CK_IntegralCast); 5012 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 5013 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5014 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5015 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5016 CK_IntegralToFloating); 5017 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 5018 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5019 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5020 } 5021 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5022 5023 case Type::STK_Floating: 5024 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5025 case Type::STK_Floating: 5026 return CK_FloatingCast; 5027 case Type::STK_Bool: 5028 return CK_FloatingToBoolean; 5029 case Type::STK_Integral: 5030 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 5031 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5032 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5033 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5034 CK_FloatingCast); 5035 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 5036 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5037 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5038 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5039 CK_FloatingToIntegral); 5040 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 5041 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5042 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5043 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5044 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?"); 5045 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5046 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5047 } 5048 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5049 5050 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5051 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5052 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5053 return CK_FloatingComplexCast; 5054 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5055 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex; 5056 case Type::STK_Floating: { 5057 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 5058 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 5059 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal; 5060 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 5061 return CK_FloatingCast; 5062 } 5063 case Type::STK_Bool: 5064 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean; 5065 case Type::STK_Integral: 5066 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5067 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5068 CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 5069 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 5070 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5071 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5072 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5073 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?"); 5074 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5075 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5076 } 5077 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5078 5079 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5080 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 5081 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 5082 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex; 5083 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 5084 return CK_IntegralComplexCast; 5085 case Type::STK_Integral: { 5086 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 5087 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 5088 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal; 5089 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 5090 return CK_IntegralCast; 5091 } 5092 case Type::STK_Bool: 5093 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean; 5094 case Type::STK_Floating: 5095 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 5096 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 5097 CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 5098 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 5099 case Type::STK_CPointer: 5100 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 5101 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 5102 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?"); 5103 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 5104 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 5105 } 5106 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 5107 } 5108 5109 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast"); 5110 } 5111 5112 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len, 5113 QualType &eltType) { 5114 // Vectors are simple. 5115 if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) { 5116 len = vecType->getNumElements(); 5117 eltType = vecType->getElementType(); 5118 assert(eltType->isScalarType()); 5119 return true; 5120 } 5121 5122 // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if 5123 // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types). 5124 if (!type->isRealType()) return false; 5125 5126 len = 1; 5127 eltType = type; 5128 return true; 5129 } 5130 5131 static bool VectorTypesMatch(Sema &S, QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 5132 uint64_t srcLen, destLen; 5133 QualType srcElt, destElt; 5134 if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcElt)) return false; 5135 if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destElt)) return false; 5136 5137 // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a 5138 // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw 5139 // element size multiplied by the element count. 5140 uint64_t srcEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(srcElt); 5141 uint64_t destEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(destElt); 5142 5143 return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize); 5144 } 5145 5146 /// Is this a legal conversion between two known vector types? 5147 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 5148 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType()); 5149 5150 if (!Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions) 5151 return false; 5152 return VectorTypesMatch(*this, srcTy, destTy); 5153 } 5154 5155 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty, 5156 CastKind &Kind) { 5157 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!"); 5158 5159 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) { 5160 if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, Ty, VectorTy)) 5161 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 5162 Ty->isVectorType() ? 5163 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors : 5164 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer) 5165 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 5166 } else 5167 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 5168 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 5169 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 5170 5171 Kind = CK_BitCast; 5172 return false; 5173 } 5174 5175 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, 5176 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) { 5177 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!"); 5178 5179 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType(); 5180 5181 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to 5182 // an ExtVectorType. 5183 // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed. 5184 // (See OpenCL 6.2). 5185 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) { 5186 if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, SrcTy, DestTy) 5187 || (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 5188 (DestTy.getCanonicalType() != SrcTy.getCanonicalType()))) { 5189 Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors) 5190 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 5191 return ExprError(); 5192 } 5193 Kind = CK_BitCast; 5194 return CastExpr; 5195 } 5196 5197 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate 5198 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then 5199 // splat from elt type to vector. 5200 if (SrcTy->isPointerType()) 5201 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 5202 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 5203 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 5204 5205 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 5206 ExprResult CastExprRes = CastExpr; 5207 CastKind CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy); 5208 if (CastExprRes.isInvalid()) 5209 return ExprError(); 5210 CastExpr = ImpCastExprToType(CastExprRes.get(), DestElemTy, CK).get(); 5211 5212 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 5213 return CastExpr; 5214 } 5215 5216 ExprResult 5217 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5218 Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty, 5219 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) { 5220 assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) && 5221 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr"); 5222 5223 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType()); 5224 if (D.isInvalidType()) 5225 return ExprError(); 5226 5227 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5228 // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only). 5229 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 5230 } 5231 5232 checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D); 5233 5234 QualType castType = castTInfo->getType(); 5235 Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo); 5236 5237 bool isVectorLiteral = false; 5238 5239 // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal, 5240 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants. 5241 ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr); 5242 ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr); 5243 if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().OpenCL) 5244 && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) { 5245 if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) { 5246 Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer); 5247 return ExprError(); 5248 } 5249 if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) { 5250 Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0)); 5251 if (!E->getType()->isVectorType()) 5252 isVectorLiteral = true; 5253 } 5254 else 5255 isVectorLiteral = true; 5256 } 5257 5258 // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')' 5259 // then handle it as such. 5260 if (isVectorLiteral) 5261 return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo); 5262 5263 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially. 5264 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a 5265 // sequence of BinOp comma operators. 5266 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) { 5267 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr); 5268 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5269 CastExpr = Result.get(); 5270 } 5271 5272 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() && 5273 !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc)) 5274 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange(); 5275 5276 CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr); 5277 5278 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr); 5279 5280 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr); 5281 } 5282 5283 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5284 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E, 5285 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 5286 assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) && 5287 "Expected paren or paren list expression"); 5288 5289 Expr **exprs; 5290 unsigned numExprs; 5291 Expr *subExpr; 5292 SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc; 5293 if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) { 5294 LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc(); 5295 LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc(); 5296 exprs = PE->getExprs(); 5297 numExprs = PE->getNumExprs(); 5298 } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance 5299 LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen(); 5300 LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen(); 5301 subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr(); 5302 exprs = &subExpr; 5303 numExprs = 1; 5304 } 5305 5306 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType(); 5307 assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type"); 5308 5309 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs; 5310 const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>(); 5311 unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements(); 5312 5313 // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of 5314 // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector. 5315 // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be 5316 // replicated to all the components of the vector 5317 if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) { 5318 // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the 5319 // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will 5320 // be replicated to all the components of the vector 5321 if (numExprs == 1) { 5322 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 5323 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 5324 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 5325 return ExprError(); 5326 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 5327 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 5328 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 5329 } 5330 else if (numExprs < numElems) { 5331 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), 5332 diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers); 5333 return ExprError(); 5334 } 5335 else 5336 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 5337 } 5338 else { 5339 // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value, 5340 // it will be replicated to all components of the vector. 5341 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 5342 VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector && 5343 numExprs == 1) { 5344 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 5345 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 5346 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 5347 return ExprError(); 5348 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 5349 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 5350 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 5351 } 5352 5353 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 5354 } 5355 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly 5356 // braces instead of the original commas. 5357 InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc, 5358 initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc); 5359 initE->setType(Ty); 5360 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE); 5361 } 5362 5363 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn 5364 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators. 5365 ExprResult 5366 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) { 5367 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr); 5368 if (!E) 5369 return OrigExpr; 5370 5371 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0)); 5372 5373 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i) 5374 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(), 5375 E->getExpr(i)); 5376 5377 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5378 5379 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get()); 5380 } 5381 5382 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L, 5383 SourceLocation R, 5384 MultiExprArg Val) { 5385 Expr *expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, Val, R); 5386 return expr; 5387 } 5388 5389 /// \brief Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer 5390 /// constant and the other is not a pointer. Returns true if a diagnostic is 5391 /// emitted. 5392 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 5393 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5394 Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr; 5395 Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr; 5396 Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind = 5397 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5398 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 5399 5400 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) { 5401 NullExpr = RHSExpr; 5402 NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr; 5403 NullKind = 5404 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5405 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 5406 } 5407 5408 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) 5409 return false; 5410 5411 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) 5412 return false; 5413 5414 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) { 5415 // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL" 5416 // string in the source code. 5417 NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 5418 SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc(); 5419 if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL")) 5420 return false; 5421 } 5422 5423 int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr); 5424 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null) 5425 << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType 5426 << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 5427 return true; 5428 } 5429 5430 /// \brief Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise. 5431 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond) { 5432 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType(); 5433 5434 // C99 6.5.15p2 5435 if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false; 5436 5437 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar. 5438 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) 5439 return false; 5440 5441 // Emit the proper error message. 5442 S.Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), S.getLangOpts().OpenCL ? 5443 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar : 5444 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector) 5445 << CondTy; 5446 return true; 5447 } 5448 5449 /// \brief Return false if the two expressions can be converted to a vector, 5450 /// true otherwise 5451 static bool checkConditionalConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5452 ExprResult &RHS, 5453 QualType CondTy) { 5454 // Both operands should be of scalar type. 5455 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) { 5456 S.Diag(LHS.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar) 5457 << CondTy; 5458 return true; 5459 } 5460 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) { 5461 S.Diag(RHS.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar) 5462 << CondTy; 5463 return true; 5464 } 5465 5466 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition. 5467 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), CondTy, CK_IntegralCast); 5468 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), CondTy, CK_IntegralCast); 5469 return false; 5470 } 5471 5472 /// \brief Handle when one or both operands are void type. 5473 static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5474 ExprResult &RHS) { 5475 Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 5476 Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get(); 5477 5478 if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 5479 S.Diag(RHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 5480 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 5481 if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 5482 S.Diag(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 5483 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 5484 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 5485 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 5486 return S.Context.VoidTy; 5487 } 5488 5489 /// \brief Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy, 5490 /// true otherwise. 5491 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr, 5492 QualType PointerTy) { 5493 if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) || 5494 !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 5495 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 5496 return true; 5497 5498 NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer); 5499 return false; 5500 } 5501 5502 /// \brief Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting 5503 /// type. 5504 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5505 ExprResult &RHS, 5506 SourceLocation Loc) { 5507 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5508 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5509 5510 if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) { 5511 // Two identical pointers types are always compatible. 5512 return LHSTy; 5513 } 5514 5515 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 5516 5517 // Get the pointee types. 5518 bool IsBlockPointer = false; 5519 if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 5520 lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType(); 5521 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5522 IsBlockPointer = true; 5523 } else { 5524 lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5525 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5526 } 5527 5528 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to 5529 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is 5530 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite 5531 // type. 5532 5533 // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified 5534 // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should 5535 // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or 5536 // anything. 5537 Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers(); 5538 Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers(); 5539 5540 unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers(); 5541 lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 5542 rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 5543 5544 lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual); 5545 rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual); 5546 5547 QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee); 5548 5549 if (CompositeTy.isNull()) { 5550 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers) 5551 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 5552 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5553 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good 5554 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick 5555 // to get a consistent AST. 5556 QualType incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy); 5557 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 5558 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 5559 return incompatTy; 5560 } 5561 5562 // The pointer types are compatible. 5563 QualType ResultTy = CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual); 5564 if (IsBlockPointer) 5565 ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy); 5566 else 5567 ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy); 5568 5569 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast); 5570 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast); 5571 return ResultTy; 5572 } 5573 5574 /// \brief Returns true if QT is quelified-id and implements 'NSObject' and/or 5575 /// 'NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else); or QT is an NSObject and optionally 5576 /// implements 'NSObject' and/or NSCopying' protocols (and nothing else). 5577 static bool isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, QualType QT) { 5578 if (QT->isObjCIdType()) 5579 return true; 5580 5581 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 5582 if (!OPT) 5583 return false; 5584 5585 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) 5586 if (ID->getIdentifier() != &C.Idents.get("NSObject")) 5587 return false; 5588 5589 ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSCopying = 5590 S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSCopying"), SourceLocation()); 5591 ObjCProtocolDecl* PNSObject = 5592 S.LookupProtocol(&C.Idents.get("NSObject"), SourceLocation()); 5593 5594 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) { 5595 if ((PNSCopying && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSCopying)) || 5596 (PNSObject && declaresSameEntity(Proto, PNSObject))) 5597 ; 5598 else 5599 return false; 5600 } 5601 return true; 5602 } 5603 5604 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers. 5605 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, 5606 ExprResult &LHS, 5607 ExprResult &RHS, 5608 SourceLocation Loc) { 5609 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5610 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5611 5612 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) { 5613 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 5614 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy); 5615 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5616 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5617 return destType; 5618 } 5619 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 5620 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 5621 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5622 return QualType(); 5623 } 5624 5625 // We have 2 block pointer types. 5626 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 5627 } 5628 5629 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers. 5630 static QualType 5631 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 5632 ExprResult &RHS, 5633 SourceLocation Loc) { 5634 // get the pointer types 5635 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5636 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5637 5638 // get the "pointed to" types 5639 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5640 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5641 5642 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6) 5643 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 5644 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6) 5645 QualType destPointee 5646 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 5647 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 5648 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 5649 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 5650 // Promote to void*. 5651 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5652 return destType; 5653 } 5654 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 5655 QualType destPointee 5656 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 5657 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 5658 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 5659 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 5660 // Promote to void*. 5661 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5662 return destType; 5663 } 5664 5665 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 5666 } 5667 5668 /// \brief Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second 5669 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise. 5670 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int, 5671 Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc, 5672 bool IsIntFirstExpr) { 5673 if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() || 5674 !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) 5675 return false; 5676 5677 Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr; 5678 Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get(); 5679 5680 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch) 5681 << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType() 5682 << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange(); 5683 Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(), 5684 CK_IntegralToPointer); 5685 return true; 5686 } 5687 5688 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension. 5689 /// In that case, LHS = cond. 5690 /// C99 6.5.15 5691 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS, 5692 ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK, 5693 ExprObjectKind &OK, 5694 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5695 5696 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 5697 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 5698 LHS = LHSResult; 5699 5700 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 5701 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 5702 RHS = RHSResult; 5703 5704 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker. 5705 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5706 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 5707 5708 VK = VK_RValue; 5709 OK = OK_Ordinary; 5710 5711 // First, check the condition. 5712 Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get()); 5713 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 5714 return QualType(); 5715 if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get())) 5716 return QualType(); 5717 5718 // Now check the two expressions. 5719 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 5720 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 5721 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false); 5722 5723 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 5724 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 5725 return QualType(); 5726 5727 QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType(); 5728 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5729 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5730 5731 // If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar, 5732 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the 5733 // built in select. (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i) 5734 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) 5735 if (checkConditionalConvertScalarsToVectors(*this, LHS, RHS, CondTy)) 5736 return QualType(); 5737 5738 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions 5739 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5. 5740 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) 5741 return LHS.get()->getType(); 5742 5743 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that 5744 // type. 5745 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3 5746 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) 5747 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl()) 5748 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has 5749 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped. 5750 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType(); 5751 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode. 5752 } 5753 5754 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type." 5755 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism). 5756 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) { 5757 return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS); 5758 } 5759 5760 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has 5761 // the type of the other operand." 5762 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy; 5763 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy; 5764 5765 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here. 5766 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS, 5767 QuestionLoc); 5768 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 5769 return QualType(); 5770 if (!compositeType.isNull()) 5771 return compositeType; 5772 5773 5774 // Handle block pointer types. 5775 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) 5776 return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 5777 QuestionLoc); 5778 5779 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6). 5780 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) 5781 return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 5782 QuestionLoc); 5783 5784 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that 5785 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point. 5786 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 5787 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/true)) 5788 return RHSTy; 5789 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 5790 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/false)) 5791 return LHSTy; 5792 5793 // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer 5794 // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most 5795 // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression. 5796 if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc)) 5797 return QualType(); 5798 5799 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible. 5800 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 5801 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 5802 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5803 return QualType(); 5804 } 5805 5806 /// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of 5807 /// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions. 5808 QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 5809 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 5810 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 5811 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 5812 5813 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result 5814 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the 5815 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields. 5816 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 5817 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 5818 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 5819 return LHSTy; 5820 } 5821 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 5822 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 5823 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 5824 return RHSTy; 5825 } 5826 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id 5827 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 5828 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 5829 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 5830 return LHSTy; 5831 } 5832 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 5833 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 5834 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 5835 return RHSTy; 5836 } 5837 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL 5838 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) && 5839 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 5840 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast); 5841 return LHSTy; 5842 } 5843 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) && 5844 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 5845 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast); 5846 return RHSTy; 5847 } 5848 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types. 5849 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 5850 5851 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) { 5852 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible. 5853 return LHSTy; 5854 } 5855 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 5856 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 5857 QualType compositeType = LHSTy; 5858 5859 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be 5860 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite 5861 // type. This allows 5862 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b 5863 // where B is a subclass of A. 5864 // 5865 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id' 5866 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are 5867 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite 5868 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to. 5869 5870 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'. 5871 // It could return the composite type. 5872 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) { 5873 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy; 5874 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) { 5875 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy; 5876 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || 5877 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) && 5878 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) { 5879 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly. 5880 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to 5881 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be 5882 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible. 5883 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5884 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) { 5885 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5886 } else if (!(compositeType = 5887 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull()) 5888 ; 5889 else { 5890 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 5891 << LHSTy << RHSTy 5892 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5893 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType(); 5894 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 5895 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 5896 return incompatTy; 5897 } 5898 // The object pointer types are compatible. 5899 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 5900 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 5901 return compositeType; 5902 } 5903 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *' 5904 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 5905 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 5906 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 5907 // so these types are not compatible. 5908 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 5909 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5910 LHS = RHS = true; 5911 return QualType(); 5912 } 5913 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5914 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5915 QualType destPointee 5916 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 5917 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 5918 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 5919 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 5920 // Promote to void*. 5921 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5922 return destType; 5923 } 5924 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 5925 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 5926 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 5927 // so these types are not compatible. 5928 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 5929 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 5930 LHS = RHS = true; 5931 return QualType(); 5932 } 5933 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5934 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 5935 QualType destPointee 5936 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 5937 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 5938 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 5939 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 5940 // Promote to void*. 5941 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 5942 return destType; 5943 } 5944 return QualType(); 5945 } 5946 5947 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps 5948 /// ParenRange in parentheses. 5949 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc, 5950 const PartialDiagnostic &Note, 5951 SourceRange ParenRange) { 5952 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd()); 5953 if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() && 5954 EndLoc.isValid()) { 5955 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) 5956 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(") 5957 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")"); 5958 } else { 5959 // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note. 5960 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange; 5961 } 5962 } 5963 5964 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 5965 return Opc >= BO_Mul && Opc <= BO_Shr; 5966 } 5967 5968 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary 5969 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator, 5970 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side 5971 /// expression. 5972 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode, 5973 Expr **RHSExprs) { 5974 // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis. 5975 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 5976 E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator(); 5977 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 5978 5979 // Built-in binary operator. 5980 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 5981 if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) { 5982 *Opcode = OP->getOpcode(); 5983 *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS(); 5984 return true; 5985 } 5986 } 5987 5988 // Overloaded operator. 5989 if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 5990 if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2) 5991 return false; 5992 5993 // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into 5994 // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op. 5995 OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator(); 5996 if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow || 5997 OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus) 5998 return false; 5999 6000 BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO); 6001 if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) { 6002 *Opcode = OpKind; 6003 *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1); 6004 return true; 6005 } 6006 } 6007 6008 return false; 6009 } 6010 6011 static bool IsLogicOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 6012 return (Opc >= BO_LT && Opc <= BO_NE) || (Opc >= BO_LAnd && Opc <= BO_LOr); 6013 } 6014 6015 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type 6016 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is 6017 /// commonly interpreted as boolean. 6018 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) { 6019 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 6020 6021 if (E->getType()->isBooleanType()) 6022 return true; 6023 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 6024 return IsLogicOp(OP->getOpcode()); 6025 if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) 6026 return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot; 6027 6028 return false; 6029 } 6030 6031 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator 6032 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed 6033 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example: 6034 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2". 6035 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self, 6036 SourceLocation OpLoc, 6037 Expr *Condition, 6038 Expr *LHSExpr, 6039 Expr *RHSExpr) { 6040 BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode; 6041 Expr *CondRHS; 6042 6043 if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS)) 6044 return; 6045 if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS)) 6046 return; 6047 6048 // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right- 6049 // hand side that looks boolean, so warn. 6050 6051 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional) 6052 << Condition->getSourceRange() 6053 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode); 6054 6055 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 6056 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 6057 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode), 6058 SourceRange(Condition->getLocStart(), Condition->getLocEnd())); 6059 6060 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 6061 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first), 6062 SourceRange(CondRHS->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd())); 6063 } 6064 6065 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null 6066 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension. 6067 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc, 6068 SourceLocation ColonLoc, 6069 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr, 6070 Expr *RHSExpr) { 6071 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS 6072 // was the condition. 6073 OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr; 6074 Expr *commonExpr = nullptr; 6075 if (!LHSExpr) { 6076 commonExpr = CondExpr; 6077 // Lower out placeholder types first. This is important so that we don't 6078 // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such 6079 // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax. 6080 if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) { 6081 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr); 6082 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 6083 commonExpr = result.get(); 6084 } 6085 // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except 6086 // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional. 6087 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 6088 && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent() 6089 && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind() 6090 && commonExpr->isGLValue() 6091 && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 6092 && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 6093 && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) { 6094 ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr); 6095 if (commonRes.isInvalid()) 6096 return ExprError(); 6097 commonExpr = commonRes.get(); 6098 } 6099 6100 opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(), 6101 commonExpr->getType(), 6102 commonExpr->getValueKind(), 6103 commonExpr->getObjectKind(), 6104 commonExpr); 6105 LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue; 6106 } 6107 6108 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 6109 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 6110 ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 6111 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, 6112 VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 6113 if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() || 6114 RHS.isInvalid()) 6115 return ExprError(); 6116 6117 DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), 6118 RHS.get()); 6119 6120 if (!commonExpr) 6121 return new (Context) 6122 ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc, 6123 RHS.get(), result, VK, OK); 6124 6125 return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator( 6126 commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 6127 ColonLoc, result, VK, OK); 6128 } 6129 6130 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite 6131 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this 6132 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee. 6133 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3]. 6134 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment. 6135 static Sema::AssignConvertType 6136 checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 6137 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 6138 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 6139 6140 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 6141 const Type *lhptee, *rhptee; 6142 Qualifiers lhq, rhq; 6143 std::tie(lhptee, lhq) = 6144 cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 6145 std::tie(rhptee, rhq) = 6146 cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 6147 6148 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 6149 6150 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints 6151 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the 6152 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right; 6153 6154 // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay. 6155 if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() && 6156 lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) { 6157 // Ignore lifetime for further calculation. 6158 lhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 6159 rhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 6160 } 6161 6162 if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) { 6163 // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal. TODO: address subspaces 6164 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) 6165 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6166 6167 // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to 6168 // and from void*. 6169 else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime() 6170 .compatiblyIncludes( 6171 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()) 6172 && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType())) 6173 ; // keep old 6174 6175 // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal. 6176 else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) 6177 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6178 6179 // For GCC compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated 6180 // as still compatible in C. 6181 else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6182 } 6183 6184 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or 6185 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified 6186 // version of void... 6187 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) { 6188 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 6189 return ConvTy; 6190 6191 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 6192 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType()); 6193 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 6194 } 6195 6196 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) { 6197 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 6198 return ConvTy; 6199 6200 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 6201 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType()); 6202 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 6203 } 6204 6205 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or 6206 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ... 6207 QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0); 6208 if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) { 6209 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign. 6210 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs 6211 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned. 6212 if (lhptee->isCharType()) 6213 ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 6214 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 6215 ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans); 6216 6217 if (rhptee->isCharType()) 6218 rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 6219 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 6220 rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans); 6221 6222 if (ltrans == rtrans) { 6223 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility 6224 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign 6225 // warning can be disabled. 6226 if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible) 6227 return ConvTy; 6228 6229 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign; 6230 } 6231 6232 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply 6233 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If 6234 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same 6235 // level of indirection, this must be the issue. 6236 if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) { 6237 do { 6238 lhptee = cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); 6239 rhptee = cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr(); 6240 } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)); 6241 6242 if (lhptee == rhptee) 6243 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers; 6244 } 6245 6246 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers. 6247 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6248 } 6249 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 6250 S.IsNoReturnConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans)) 6251 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6252 return ConvTy; 6253 } 6254 6255 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two 6256 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer 6257 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer 6258 // types. 6259 static Sema::AssignConvertType 6260 checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 6261 QualType RHSType) { 6262 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 6263 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 6264 6265 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 6266 6267 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 6268 lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType(); 6269 rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType(); 6270 6271 // In C++, the types have to match exactly. 6272 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 6273 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 6274 6275 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 6276 6277 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical. 6278 if (lhptee.getLocalQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalQualifiers()) 6279 ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6280 6281 if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 6282 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 6283 6284 return ConvTy; 6285 } 6286 6287 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types 6288 /// for assignment compatibility. 6289 static Sema::AssignConvertType 6290 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 6291 QualType RHSType) { 6292 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!"); 6293 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!"); 6294 6295 if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 6296 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers. 6297 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 6298 !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 6299 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6300 return Sema::Compatible; 6301 } 6302 if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 6303 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 6304 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 6305 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6306 return Sema::Compatible; 6307 } 6308 QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6309 QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6310 6311 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) && 6312 // make an exception for id<P> 6313 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 6314 return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 6315 6316 if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 6317 return Sema::Compatible; 6318 if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 6319 return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId; 6320 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 6321 } 6322 6323 Sema::AssignConvertType 6324 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc, 6325 QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 6326 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what 6327 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints 6328 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't 6329 // usually happen on valid code. 6330 OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue); 6331 ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr; 6332 CastKind K = CK_Invalid; 6333 6334 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K); 6335 } 6336 6337 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently 6338 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking 6339 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings: 6340 /// 6341 /// int a, *pint; 6342 /// short *pshort; 6343 /// struct foo *pfoo; 6344 /// 6345 /// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 6346 /// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast 6347 /// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast 6348 /// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 6349 /// 6350 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the 6351 /// C99 spec dictates. 6352 /// 6353 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible. 6354 Sema::AssignConvertType 6355 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, 6356 CastKind &Kind) { 6357 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 6358 QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType; 6359 6360 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing 6361 // them. 6362 LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6363 RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 6364 6365 // Common case: no conversion required. 6366 if (LHSType == RHSType) { 6367 Kind = CK_NoOp; 6368 return Compatible; 6369 } 6370 6371 // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an 6372 // atomic qualification step. 6373 if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) { 6374 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 6375 CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind); 6376 if (result != Compatible) 6377 return result; 6378 if (Kind != CK_NoOp) 6379 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind); 6380 Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic; 6381 return Compatible; 6382 } 6383 6384 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a 6385 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C, 6386 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case, 6387 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the 6388 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting 6389 // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference 6390 // type. 6391 if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 6392 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) { 6393 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast; 6394 return Compatible; 6395 } 6396 return Incompatible; 6397 } 6398 6399 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type 6400 // to the same ExtVector type. 6401 if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) { 6402 if (RHSType->isExtVectorType()) 6403 return Incompatible; 6404 if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) { 6405 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the 6406 // element type. 6407 QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(LHSType)->getElementType(); 6408 if (elType != RHSType) { 6409 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, elType); 6410 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), elType, Kind); 6411 } 6412 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 6413 return Compatible; 6414 } 6415 } 6416 6417 // Conversions to or from vector type. 6418 if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) { 6419 if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) { 6420 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC 6421 // vector type and vice versa 6422 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 6423 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6424 return Compatible; 6425 } 6426 6427 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both 6428 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast; 6429 // no bits are changed but the result type is different. 6430 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 6431 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6432 return IncompatibleVectors; 6433 } 6434 } 6435 return Incompatible; 6436 } 6437 6438 // Arithmetic conversions. 6439 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() && 6440 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) { 6441 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType); 6442 return Compatible; 6443 } 6444 6445 // Conversions to normal pointers. 6446 if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) { 6447 // U* -> T* 6448 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 6449 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6450 return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 6451 } 6452 6453 // int -> T* 6454 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6455 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null? 6456 return IntToPointer; 6457 } 6458 6459 // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 6460 // with two exceptions: 6461 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 6462 // - conversions to void* 6463 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6464 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6465 return Compatible; 6466 } 6467 6468 // - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type 6469 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && 6470 Context.hasSameType(LHSType, 6471 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 6472 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6473 return Compatible; 6474 } 6475 6476 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6477 return IncompatiblePointer; 6478 } 6479 6480 // U^ -> void* 6481 if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 6482 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6483 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6484 return Compatible; 6485 } 6486 } 6487 6488 return Incompatible; 6489 } 6490 6491 // Conversions to block pointers. 6492 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) { 6493 // U^ -> T^ 6494 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 6495 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6496 return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 6497 } 6498 6499 // int or null -> T^ 6500 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6501 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 6502 return IntToBlockPointer; 6503 } 6504 6505 // id -> T^ 6506 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) { 6507 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 6508 return Compatible; 6509 } 6510 6511 // void* -> T^ 6512 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) 6513 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6514 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 6515 return Compatible; 6516 } 6517 6518 return Incompatible; 6519 } 6520 6521 // Conversions to Objective-C pointers. 6522 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) { 6523 // A* -> B* 6524 if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 6525 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6526 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 6527 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 6528 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 6529 result == Compatible && 6530 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType)) 6531 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 6532 return result; 6533 } 6534 6535 // int or null -> A* 6536 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6537 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 6538 return IntToPointer; 6539 } 6540 6541 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 6542 // with two exceptions: 6543 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 6544 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6545 6546 // - conversions from 'void*' 6547 if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) { 6548 return Compatible; 6549 } 6550 6551 // - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type 6552 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && 6553 Context.hasSameType(RHSType, 6554 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 6555 return Compatible; 6556 } 6557 6558 return IncompatiblePointer; 6559 } 6560 6561 // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer. 6562 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 6563 isObjCPtrBlockCompatible(*this, Context, LHSType)) { 6564 maybeExtendBlockObject(*this, RHS); 6565 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6566 return Compatible; 6567 } 6568 6569 return Incompatible; 6570 } 6571 6572 // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above. 6573 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 6574 // T* -> _Bool 6575 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 6576 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 6577 return Compatible; 6578 } 6579 6580 // T* -> int 6581 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6582 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 6583 return PointerToInt; 6584 } 6585 6586 return Incompatible; 6587 } 6588 6589 // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above. 6590 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 6591 // T* -> _Bool 6592 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 6593 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 6594 return Compatible; 6595 } 6596 6597 // T* -> int 6598 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 6599 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 6600 return PointerToInt; 6601 } 6602 6603 return Incompatible; 6604 } 6605 6606 // struct A -> struct B 6607 if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) { 6608 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 6609 Kind = CK_NoOp; 6610 return Compatible; 6611 } 6612 } 6613 6614 return Incompatible; 6615 } 6616 6617 /// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is 6618 /// used to initialize the transparent union. 6619 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, 6620 ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType, 6621 FieldDecl *Field) { 6622 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member 6623 // of the transparent union. 6624 Expr *E = EResult.get(); 6625 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(), 6626 E, SourceLocation()); 6627 Initializer->setType(UnionType); 6628 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field); 6629 6630 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent 6631 // union type from this initializer list. 6632 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType); 6633 EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType, 6634 VK_RValue, Initializer, false); 6635 } 6636 6637 Sema::AssignConvertType 6638 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, 6639 ExprResult &RHS) { 6640 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 6641 6642 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential 6643 // transparent_union GCC extension. 6644 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType(); 6645 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 6646 return Incompatible; 6647 6648 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 6649 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 6650 FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr; 6651 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 6652 for (auto *it : UD->fields()) { 6653 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) { 6654 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow: 6655 // 1) void pointer 6656 // 2) null pointer constant 6657 if (RHSType->isPointerType()) 6658 if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 6659 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast); 6660 InitField = it; 6661 break; 6662 } 6663 6664 if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6665 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 6666 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), 6667 CK_NullToPointer); 6668 InitField = it; 6669 break; 6670 } 6671 } 6672 6673 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid; 6674 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind) 6675 == Compatible) { 6676 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind); 6677 InitField = it; 6678 break; 6679 } 6680 } 6681 6682 if (!InitField) 6683 return Incompatible; 6684 6685 ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField); 6686 return Compatible; 6687 } 6688 6689 Sema::AssignConvertType 6690 Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, 6691 bool Diagnose, 6692 bool DiagnoseCFAudited) { 6693 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6694 if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) { 6695 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the 6696 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the 6697 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand. 6698 ExprResult Res; 6699 if (Diagnose) { 6700 Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 6701 AA_Assigning); 6702 } else { 6703 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 6704 TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 6705 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 6706 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 6707 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 6708 /*CStyle=*/false, 6709 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 6710 if (ICS.isFailure()) 6711 return Incompatible; 6712 Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 6713 ICS, AA_Assigning); 6714 } 6715 if (Res.isInvalid()) 6716 return Incompatible; 6717 Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible; 6718 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 6719 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType, 6720 RHS.get()->getType())) 6721 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 6722 RHS = Res; 6723 return result; 6724 } 6725 6726 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C 6727 // structures. 6728 // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should 6729 // happen there, though. 6730 } 6731 6732 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is 6733 // a null pointer constant. 6734 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 6735 LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) && 6736 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6737 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 6738 CastKind Kind; 6739 CXXCastPath Path; 6740 CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path, false); 6741 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path); 6742 return Compatible; 6743 } 6744 6745 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper 6746 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all 6747 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary 6748 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof). 6749 // 6750 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5. 6751 if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) { 6752 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 6753 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 6754 return Incompatible; 6755 } 6756 6757 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid; 6758 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 6759 CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind); 6760 6761 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the 6762 // type of the assignment expression. 6763 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference, 6764 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C. 6765 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression 6766 // does not have reference type. 6767 if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) { 6768 QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 6769 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 6770 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 6771 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, 6772 DiagnoseCFAudited); 6773 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && 6774 (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getLocStart(), 6775 LHSType, E->getType(), E) || 6776 ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E))) { 6777 RHS = E; 6778 return Compatible; 6779 } 6780 6781 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind); 6782 } 6783 return result; 6784 } 6785 6786 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, 6787 ExprResult &RHS) { 6788 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands) 6789 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 6790 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6791 return QualType(); 6792 } 6793 6794 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting 6795 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat. 6796 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar 6797 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except 6798 /// for float->int. 6799 /// 6800 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions 6801 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure) 6802 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar, 6803 QualType scalarTy, 6804 QualType vectorEltTy, 6805 QualType vectorTy) { 6806 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it, 6807 // if necessary. 6808 CastKind scalarCast = CK_Invalid; 6809 6810 if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 6811 if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 6812 return true; 6813 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 6814 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) 6815 return true; 6816 scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast; 6817 } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 6818 if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 6819 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 6820 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) 6821 return true; 6822 scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast; 6823 } 6824 else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 6825 scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating; 6826 else 6827 return true; 6828 } else { 6829 return true; 6830 } 6831 6832 // Adjust scalar if desired. 6833 if (scalar) { 6834 if (scalarCast != CK_Invalid) 6835 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast); 6836 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 6837 } 6838 return false; 6839 } 6840 6841 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 6842 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 6843 if (!IsCompAssign) { 6844 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 6845 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 6846 return QualType(); 6847 } 6848 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 6849 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 6850 return QualType(); 6851 6852 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 6853 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 6854 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 6855 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 6856 6857 // If the vector types are identical, return. 6858 if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType)) 6859 return LHSType; 6860 6861 const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 6862 const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 6863 assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType); 6864 6865 // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type. 6866 if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType && 6867 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 6868 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 6869 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 6870 return LHSType; 6871 } 6872 6873 if (!IsCompAssign) 6874 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 6875 return RHSType; 6876 } 6877 6878 // If there's an ext-vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to 6879 // the vector element type and splat. 6880 if (!RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 6881 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType, 6882 LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType)) 6883 return LHSType; 6884 } 6885 if (!LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) { 6886 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS), 6887 LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(), 6888 RHSType)) 6889 return RHSType; 6890 } 6891 6892 // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size 6893 // needs to be the same. 6894 // FIXME: Should we really be allowing this? 6895 // FIXME: We really just pick the LHS type arbitrarily? 6896 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 6897 QualType resultType = LHSType; 6898 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), resultType, CK_BitCast); 6899 return resultType; 6900 } 6901 6902 // Okay, the expression is invalid. 6903 6904 // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that. 6905 if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) || 6906 (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) { 6907 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar) 6908 << LHSType << RHSType 6909 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6910 return QualType(); 6911 } 6912 6913 // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic. 6914 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable) 6915 << LHSType << RHSType 6916 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6917 return QualType(); 6918 } 6919 6920 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an 6921 // expression. These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an 6922 // integer instead of a pointer. 6923 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 6924 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) { 6925 // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant, 6926 // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively 6927 // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow. 6928 bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 6929 bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 6930 6931 QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType(); 6932 6933 // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and 6934 // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about. 6935 if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() || 6936 NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType()) 6937 return; 6938 6939 // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter 6940 // what the other expression is. 6941 if (!IsCompare) { 6942 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation) 6943 << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 6944 << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 6945 return; 6946 } 6947 6948 // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer 6949 // if the other expression is a pointer. 6950 if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() || 6951 NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType()) 6952 return; 6953 6954 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation) 6955 << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType 6956 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6957 } 6958 6959 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 6960 SourceLocation Loc, 6961 bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) { 6962 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 6963 6964 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 6965 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 6966 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 6967 6968 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 6969 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 6970 return QualType(); 6971 6972 6973 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType()) 6974 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 6975 6976 // Check for division by zero. 6977 llvm::APSInt RHSValue; 6978 if (IsDiv && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 6979 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0) 6980 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 6981 PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero) 6982 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 6983 6984 return compType; 6985 } 6986 6987 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands( 6988 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 6989 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 6990 6991 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 6992 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 6993 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 6994 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 6995 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 6996 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 6997 } 6998 6999 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 7000 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7001 return QualType(); 7002 7003 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType()) 7004 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7005 7006 // Check for remainder by zero. 7007 llvm::APSInt RHSValue; 7008 if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 7009 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0) 7010 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7011 PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero) 7012 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7013 7014 return compType; 7015 } 7016 7017 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers. 7018 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7019 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7020 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7021 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 7022 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 7023 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 7024 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 7025 } 7026 7027 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer. 7028 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7029 Expr *Pointer) { 7030 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7031 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 7032 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 7033 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 7034 } 7035 7036 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers. 7037 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7038 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 7039 assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7040 assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7041 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7042 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 7043 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 7044 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 7045 // We only show the second type if it differs from the first. 7046 << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(), 7047 RHS->getType()) 7048 << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 7049 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 7050 } 7051 7052 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer. 7053 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7054 Expr *Pointer) { 7055 assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7056 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7057 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 7058 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 7059 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType() 7060 << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */ 7061 << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 7062 } 7063 7064 /// \brief Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type 7065 /// 7066 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type 7067 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7068 Expr *Operand) { 7069 assert(Operand->getType()->isAnyPointerType() && 7070 !Operand->getType()->isDependentType()); 7071 QualType PointeeTy = Operand->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7072 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy, 7073 diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type, 7074 PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange()); 7075 } 7076 7077 /// \brief Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand. 7078 /// 7079 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types 7080 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed 7081 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an 7082 /// extension. 7083 /// 7084 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 7085 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7086 Expr *Operand) { 7087 if (!Operand->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) return true; 7088 7089 QualType PointeeTy = Operand->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7090 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) { 7091 diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 7092 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7093 } 7094 if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 7095 diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 7096 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7097 } 7098 7099 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false; 7100 7101 return true; 7102 } 7103 7104 /// \brief Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer 7105 /// operands. 7106 /// 7107 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much 7108 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic 7109 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS 7110 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers. 7111 /// 7112 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 7113 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7114 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7115 bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 7116 bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 7117 if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true; 7118 7119 QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy; 7120 if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7121 if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7122 7123 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types. 7124 bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 7125 bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 7126 if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) { 7127 if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 7128 else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr); 7129 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 7130 7131 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7132 } 7133 7134 bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 7135 bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 7136 if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) { 7137 if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 7138 else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, 7139 RHSExpr); 7140 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 7141 7142 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 7143 } 7144 7145 if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr)) 7146 return false; 7147 if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr)) 7148 return false; 7149 7150 return true; 7151 } 7152 7153 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string 7154 /// literal. 7155 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 7156 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7157 StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7158 Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr; 7159 if (!StrExpr) { 7160 StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7161 IndexExpr = LHSExpr; 7162 } 7163 7164 bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr && 7165 IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 7166 if (!IsStringPlusInt) 7167 return; 7168 7169 llvm::APSInt index; 7170 if (IndexExpr->EvaluateAsInt(index, Self.getASTContext())) { 7171 unsigned StrLenWithNull = StrExpr->getLength() + 1; 7172 if (index.isNonNegative() && 7173 index <= llvm::APSInt(llvm::APInt(index.getBitWidth(), StrLenWithNull), 7174 index.isUnsigned())) 7175 return; 7176 } 7177 7178 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7179 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int) 7180 << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 7181 7182 // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str". 7183 if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) { 7184 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7185 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 7186 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&") 7187 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 7188 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 7189 } else 7190 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 7191 } 7192 7193 /// \brief Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string. 7194 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 7195 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7196 const DeclRefExpr *StringRefExpr = 7197 dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7198 const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr = 7199 dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7200 if (!StringRefExpr) { 7201 StringRefExpr = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7202 CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7203 } 7204 7205 if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr) 7206 return; 7207 7208 const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType(); 7209 7210 // Return if not a PointerType. 7211 if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType()) 7212 return; 7213 7214 // Return if not a CharacterType. 7215 if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType()) 7216 return; 7217 7218 ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext(); 7219 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7220 7221 const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType(); 7222 if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() && 7223 CharType->isIntegerType() && 7224 llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) { 7225 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 7226 << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy; 7227 } else { 7228 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 7229 << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType(); 7230 } 7231 7232 // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str. 7233 if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) { 7234 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 7235 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 7236 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&") 7237 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 7238 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 7239 } else { 7240 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 7241 } 7242 } 7243 7244 /// \brief Emit error when two pointers are incompatible. 7245 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7246 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 7247 assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7248 assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7249 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible) 7250 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 7251 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 7252 } 7253 7254 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6 7255 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc, 7256 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 7257 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7258 7259 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7260 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7261 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy); 7262 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7263 return compType; 7264 } 7265 7266 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 7267 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7268 return QualType(); 7269 7270 // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal". 7271 if (Opc == BO_Add) { 7272 diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7273 diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7274 } 7275 7276 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 7277 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 7278 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7279 return compType; 7280 } 7281 7282 // Type-checking. Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp; 7283 // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer. 7284 Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get(); 7285 7286 bool isObjCPointer; 7287 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 7288 isObjCPointer = false; 7289 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7290 isObjCPointer = true; 7291 } else { 7292 std::swap(PExp, IExp); 7293 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 7294 isObjCPointer = false; 7295 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7296 isObjCPointer = true; 7297 } else { 7298 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7299 } 7300 } 7301 assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 7302 7303 if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) 7304 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7305 7306 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp)) 7307 return QualType(); 7308 7309 if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp)) 7310 return QualType(); 7311 7312 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 7313 CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp); 7314 7315 if (CompLHSTy) { 7316 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 7317 if (LHSTy.isNull()) { 7318 LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7319 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 7320 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy); 7321 } 7322 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy; 7323 } 7324 7325 return PExp->getType(); 7326 } 7327 7328 // C99 6.5.6 7329 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7330 SourceLocation Loc, 7331 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 7332 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7333 7334 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7335 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7336 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy); 7337 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7338 return compType; 7339 } 7340 7341 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 7342 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7343 return QualType(); 7344 7345 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3. 7346 7347 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 7348 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 7349 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 7350 return compType; 7351 } 7352 7353 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr. 7354 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) { 7355 QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType(); 7356 7357 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts. 7358 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 7359 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 7360 return QualType(); 7361 7362 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type. 7363 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) { 7364 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 7365 return QualType(); 7366 7367 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 7368 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr, 7369 /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true); 7370 7371 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7372 return LHS.get()->getType(); 7373 } 7374 7375 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions. 7376 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy 7377 = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 7378 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType(); 7379 7380 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7381 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add] 7382 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) { 7383 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7384 } 7385 } else { 7386 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3 7387 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible( 7388 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(), 7389 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) { 7390 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7391 return QualType(); 7392 } 7393 } 7394 7395 if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc, 7396 LHS.get(), RHS.get())) 7397 return QualType(); 7398 7399 // The pointee type may have zero size. As an extension, a structure or 7400 // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length. In this 7401 // case subtraction does not make sense. 7402 if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) { 7403 CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee); 7404 if (ElementSize.isZero()) { 7405 Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types) 7406 << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType() 7407 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7408 } 7409 } 7410 7411 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7412 return Context.getPointerDiffType(); 7413 } 7414 } 7415 7416 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7417 } 7418 7419 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) { 7420 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T)) 7421 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped(); 7422 return false; 7423 } 7424 7425 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7426 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc, 7427 QualType LHSType) { 7428 // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined), 7429 // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema. 7430 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) 7431 return; 7432 7433 llvm::APSInt Right; 7434 // Check right/shifter operand 7435 if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 7436 !RHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, S.Context)) 7437 return; 7438 7439 if (Right.isNegative()) { 7440 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7441 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative) 7442 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7443 return; 7444 } 7445 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(), 7446 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType())); 7447 if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) { 7448 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 7449 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) 7450 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7451 return; 7452 } 7453 if (Opc != BO_Shl) 7454 return; 7455 7456 // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which 7457 // according to C++ has undefined behavior ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned 7458 // integers have defined behavior modulo one more than the maximum value 7459 // representable in the result type, so never warn for those. 7460 llvm::APSInt Left; 7461 if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 7462 !LHS.get()->isIntegerConstantExpr(Left, S.Context) || 7463 LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation()) 7464 return; 7465 llvm::APInt ResultBits = 7466 static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits(); 7467 if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits)) 7468 return; 7469 llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue()); 7470 Result = Result.shl(Right); 7471 7472 // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned 7473 // hexadecimal number. 7474 SmallString<40> HexResult; 7475 Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true); 7476 7477 // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual 7478 // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the 7479 // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be 7480 // turned off separately if needed. 7481 if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) { 7482 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit) 7483 << HexResult.str() << LHSType 7484 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7485 return; 7486 } 7487 7488 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth) 7489 << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType 7490 << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 7491 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7492 } 7493 7494 // C99 6.5.7 7495 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7496 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc, 7497 bool IsCompAssign) { 7498 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 7499 7500 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type. 7501 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7502 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 7503 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 7504 7505 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer 7506 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3 7507 7508 // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away 7509 // if this is a compound assignment. 7510 ExprResult OldLHS = LHS; 7511 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 7512 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 7513 return QualType(); 7514 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 7515 if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS; 7516 7517 // The RHS is simpler. 7518 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 7519 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 7520 return QualType(); 7521 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7522 7523 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type. 7524 if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() || 7525 !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 7526 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7527 7528 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than 7529 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this. 7530 if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) || 7531 isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) { 7532 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 7533 } 7534 // Sanity-check shift operands 7535 DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType); 7536 7537 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand." 7538 return LHSType; 7539 } 7540 7541 static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) { 7542 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) { 7543 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC)) 7544 return true; 7545 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)) 7546 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization(); 7547 } 7548 return false; 7549 } 7550 7551 /// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning. 7552 static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS, 7553 Expr *RHS) { 7554 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 7555 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 7556 7557 const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 7558 if (!LHSEnumType) 7559 return; 7560 const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 7561 if (!RHSEnumType) 7562 return; 7563 7564 // Ignore anonymous enums. 7565 if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier()) 7566 return; 7567 if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier()) 7568 return; 7569 7570 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) 7571 return; 7572 7573 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types) 7574 << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType 7575 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 7576 } 7577 7578 /// \brief Diagnose bad pointer comparisons. 7579 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7580 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7581 bool IsError) { 7582 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers 7583 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers) 7584 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 7585 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7586 } 7587 7588 /// \brief Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type, 7589 /// true otherwise. 7590 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7591 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) { 7592 // C++ [expr.rel]p2: 7593 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification 7594 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on 7595 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring 7596 // them to their composite pointer type. [...] 7597 // 7598 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality 7599 // comparisons of pointers. 7600 7601 // C++ [expr.eq]p2: 7602 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to 7603 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions 7604 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring 7605 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant, 7606 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the 7607 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type 7608 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4) 7609 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand 7610 // types. 7611 7612 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 7613 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7614 assert((LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) || 7615 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType())); 7616 7617 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false; 7618 bool *BoolPtr = S.isSFINAEContext() ? nullptr : &NonStandardCompositeType; 7619 QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS, BoolPtr); 7620 if (T.isNull()) { 7621 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true); 7622 return true; 7623 } 7624 7625 if (NonStandardCompositeType) 7626 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard) 7627 << LHSType << RHSType << T << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 7628 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7629 7630 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 7631 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 7632 return false; 7633 } 7634 7635 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7636 ExprResult &LHS, 7637 ExprResult &RHS, 7638 bool IsError) { 7639 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void 7640 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void) 7641 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 7642 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7643 } 7644 7645 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) { 7646 switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) { 7647 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 7648 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 7649 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 7650 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: 7651 return true; 7652 default: 7653 // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal! 7654 return false; 7655 } 7656 } 7657 7658 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) { 7659 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type = 7660 LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7661 7662 // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out. 7663 if (!Type) 7664 return false; 7665 7666 // Get the LHS object's interface type. 7667 QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType(); 7668 if (const ObjCObjectType *iQFaceTy = 7669 InterfaceType->getAsObjCQualifiedInterfaceType()) 7670 InterfaceType = iQFaceTy->getBaseType(); 7671 7672 // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out. 7673 if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 7674 return false; 7675 7676 // Try to find the -isEqual: method. 7677 Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector(); 7678 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel, 7679 InterfaceType, 7680 /*instance=*/true); 7681 if (!Method) { 7682 if (Type->isObjCIdType()) { 7683 // For 'id', just check the global pool. 7684 Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(), 7685 /*receiverId=*/true, 7686 /*warn=*/false); 7687 } else { 7688 // Check protocols. 7689 Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type, 7690 /*instance=*/true); 7691 } 7692 } 7693 7694 if (!Method) 7695 return false; 7696 7697 QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType(); 7698 if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 7699 return false; 7700 7701 QualType R = Method->getReturnType(); 7702 if (!R->isScalarType()) 7703 return false; 7704 7705 return true; 7706 } 7707 7708 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) { 7709 FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 7710 switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) { 7711 default: 7712 break; 7713 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 7714 // "string literal" 7715 return LK_String; 7716 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 7717 // "array literal" 7718 return LK_Array; 7719 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 7720 // "dictionary literal" 7721 return LK_Dictionary; 7722 case Stmt::BlockExprClass: 7723 return LK_Block; 7724 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: { 7725 Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 7726 switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) { 7727 case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass: 7728 case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass: 7729 case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass: 7730 case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass: 7731 case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass: 7732 // "numeric literal" 7733 return LK_Numeric; 7734 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: { 7735 CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind(); 7736 // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts. 7737 if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast) 7738 return LK_Numeric; 7739 break; 7740 } 7741 default: 7742 break; 7743 } 7744 return LK_Boxed; 7745 } 7746 } 7747 return LK_None; 7748 } 7749 7750 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 7751 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7752 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){ 7753 Expr *Literal; 7754 Expr *Other; 7755 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) { 7756 Literal = LHS.get(); 7757 Other = RHS.get(); 7758 } else { 7759 Literal = RHS.get(); 7760 Other = LHS.get(); 7761 } 7762 7763 // Don't warn on comparisons against nil. 7764 Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts(); 7765 if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(), 7766 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) 7767 return; 7768 7769 // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison. 7770 // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own 7771 // warning flag. 7772 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal); 7773 assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block); 7774 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) { 7775 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind"); 7776 } 7777 7778 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String) 7779 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison) 7780 << Literal->getSourceRange(); 7781 else 7782 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison) 7783 << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange(); 7784 7785 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) && 7786 hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) { 7787 SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getLocStart(); 7788 SourceLocation End = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd()); 7789 CharSourceRange OpRange = 7790 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)); 7791 7792 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal) 7793 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![") 7794 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:") 7795 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]"); 7796 } 7797 } 7798 7799 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 7800 ExprResult &RHS, 7801 SourceLocation Loc, 7802 unsigned OpaqueOpc) { 7803 // This checking requires bools. 7804 if (!S.getLangOpts().Bool) return; 7805 7806 // Check that left hand side is !something. 7807 UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 7808 if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return; 7809 7810 // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type. 7811 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType()) return; 7812 7813 // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool. 7814 Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7815 if (SubExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) return; 7816 7817 // Emit warning. 7818 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_comparison) 7819 << Loc; 7820 7821 // First note suggest !(x < y) 7822 SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getLocStart(); 7823 SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getLocEnd(); 7824 FirstClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose); 7825 if (FirstClose.isInvalid()) 7826 FirstOpen = SourceLocation(); 7827 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix) 7828 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(") 7829 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")"); 7830 7831 // Second note suggests (!x) < y 7832 SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getLocStart(); 7833 SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getLocEnd(); 7834 SecondClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose); 7835 if (SecondClose.isInvalid()) 7836 SecondOpen = SourceLocation(); 7837 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens) 7838 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(") 7839 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")"); 7840 } 7841 7842 // Get the decl for a simple expression: a reference to a variable, 7843 // an implicit C++ field reference, or an implicit ObjC ivar reference. 7844 static ValueDecl *getCompareDecl(Expr *E) { 7845 if (DeclRefExpr* DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 7846 return DR->getDecl(); 7847 if (ObjCIvarRefExpr* Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) { 7848 if (Ivar->isFreeIvar()) 7849 return Ivar->getDecl(); 7850 } 7851 if (MemberExpr* Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 7852 if (Mem->isImplicitAccess()) 7853 return Mem->getMemberDecl(); 7854 } 7855 return nullptr; 7856 } 7857 7858 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel] 7859 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7860 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned OpaqueOpc, 7861 bool IsRelational) { 7862 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/true); 7863 7864 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc; 7865 7866 // Handle vector comparisons separately. 7867 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7868 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 7869 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsRelational); 7870 7871 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 7872 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7873 7874 Expr *LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 7875 Expr *RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 7876 7877 checkEnumComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7878 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, OpaqueOpc); 7879 7880 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() && 7881 !(LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && IsRelational) && 7882 !LHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() && 7883 !RHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() && 7884 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 7885 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 7886 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 7887 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 7888 // 7889 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro 7890 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self 7891 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch 7892 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to 7893 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same 7894 // result. 7895 ValueDecl *DL = getCompareDecl(LHSStripped); 7896 ValueDecl *DR = getCompareDecl(RHSStripped); 7897 if (DL && DR && DL == DR && !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DL)) { 7898 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 7899 << 0 // self- 7900 << (Opc == BO_EQ 7901 || Opc == BO_LE 7902 || Opc == BO_GE)); 7903 } else if (DL && DR && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType() && 7904 !DL->getType()->isReferenceType() && 7905 !DR->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 7906 // what is it always going to eval to? 7907 char always_evals_to; 7908 switch(Opc) { 7909 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2 7910 always_evals_to = 0; // false 7911 break; 7912 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2 7913 always_evals_to = 1; // true 7914 break; 7915 default: 7916 // best we can say is 'a constant' 7917 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2 7918 break; 7919 } 7920 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 7921 << 1 // array 7922 << always_evals_to); 7923 } 7924 7925 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped)) 7926 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 7927 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped)) 7928 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 7929 7930 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other 7931 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp. 7932 Expr *literalString = nullptr; 7933 Expr *literalStringStripped = nullptr; 7934 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) && 7935 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 7936 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 7937 literalString = LHS.get(); 7938 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped; 7939 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) || 7940 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) && 7941 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 7942 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 7943 literalString = RHS.get(); 7944 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped; 7945 } 7946 7947 if (literalString) { 7948 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 7949 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare) 7950 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped) 7951 << literalString->getSourceRange()); 7952 } 7953 } 7954 7955 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4 7956 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 7957 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7958 return QualType(); 7959 7960 LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 7961 RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 7962 7963 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C. 7964 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 7965 7966 if (IsRelational) { 7967 if (LHSType->isRealType() && RHSType->isRealType()) 7968 return ResultTy; 7969 } else { 7970 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 7971 if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 7972 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 7973 7974 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType()) 7975 return ResultTy; 7976 } 7977 7978 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind = 7979 LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 7980 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind = 7981 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 7982 bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 7983 bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 7984 7985 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) { 7986 bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ; 7987 if (RHSIsNull) 7988 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality, 7989 RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7990 else 7991 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality, 7992 LHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 7993 } 7994 7995 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except 7996 // when handling null pointer constants. 7997 if (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2 7998 QualType LCanPointeeTy = 7999 LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 8000 QualType RCanPointeeTy = 8001 RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 8002 8003 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8004 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy) 8005 return ResultTy; 8006 if (!IsRelational && 8007 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) { 8008 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer 8009 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison. 8010 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain 8011 // conformance with the C++ standard. 8012 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8013 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 8014 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison( 8015 *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext()); 8016 8017 if (isSFINAEContext()) 8018 return QualType(); 8019 8020 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8021 return ResultTy; 8022 } 8023 } 8024 8025 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 8026 return QualType(); 8027 else 8028 return ResultTy; 8029 } 8030 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2 8031 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), 8032 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) { 8033 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers 8034 if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 8035 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers) 8036 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8037 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8038 } 8039 } else if (!IsRelational && 8040 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) { 8041 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer 8042 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 8043 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8044 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 8045 /*isError*/false); 8046 } else { 8047 // Invalid 8048 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false); 8049 } 8050 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) { 8051 unsigned AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 8052 unsigned AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 8053 CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion 8054 : CK_BitCast; 8055 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8056 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind); 8057 else 8058 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind); 8059 } 8060 return ResultTy; 8061 } 8062 8063 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8064 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself. 8065 if (LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isNullPtrType()) 8066 return ResultTy; 8067 8068 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality 8069 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants. 8070 if (RHSIsNull && 8071 ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() || LHSType->isNullPtrType()) || 8072 (!IsRelational && 8073 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) { 8074 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 8075 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() 8076 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer 8077 : CK_NullToPointer); 8078 return ResultTy; 8079 } 8080 if (LHSIsNull && 8081 ((RHSType->isAnyPointerType() || RHSType->isNullPtrType()) || 8082 (!IsRelational && 8083 (RHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) { 8084 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 8085 RHSType->isMemberPointerType() 8086 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer 8087 : CK_NullToPointer); 8088 return ResultTy; 8089 } 8090 8091 // Comparison of member pointers. 8092 if (!IsRelational && 8093 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()) { 8094 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 8095 return QualType(); 8096 else 8097 return ResultTy; 8098 } 8099 8100 // Handle scoped enumeration types specifically, since they don't promote 8101 // to integers. 8102 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isEnumeralType() && 8103 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS.get()->getType(), 8104 RHS.get()->getType())) 8105 return ResultTy; 8106 } 8107 8108 // Handle block pointer types. 8109 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 8110 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 8111 QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8112 QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 8113 8114 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull && 8115 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) { 8116 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 8117 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8118 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8119 } 8120 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8121 return ResultTy; 8122 } 8123 8124 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants. 8125 if (!IsRelational 8126 && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) 8127 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) { 8128 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 8129 if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 8130 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) 8131 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 8132 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()))) 8133 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 8134 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8135 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8136 } 8137 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8138 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 8139 RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 8140 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 8141 else 8142 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 8143 LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 8144 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 8145 return ResultTy; 8146 } 8147 8148 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 8149 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8150 const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 8151 const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 8152 if (LPT || RPT) { 8153 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 8154 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 8155 8156 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid && 8157 !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8158 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 8159 /*isError*/false); 8160 } 8161 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 8162 Expr *E = LHS.get(); 8163 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 8164 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion); 8165 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType, 8166 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 8167 } 8168 else { 8169 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 8170 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 8171 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, false, 8172 Opc); 8173 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType, 8174 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 8175 } 8176 return ResultTy; 8177 } 8178 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 8179 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8180 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) 8181 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 8182 /*isError*/false); 8183 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS)) 8184 diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc); 8185 8186 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 8187 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 8188 else 8189 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8190 return ResultTy; 8191 } 8192 } 8193 if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) || 8194 (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) { 8195 unsigned DiagID = 0; 8196 bool isError = false; 8197 if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) { 8198 // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers, 8199 // since users tend to want to compare addresses. 8200 } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) || 8201 (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) { 8202 if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 8203 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero; 8204 } else if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 8205 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 8206 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8207 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 8208 isError = true; 8209 } else 8210 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 8211 8212 if (DiagID) { 8213 Diag(Loc, DiagID) 8214 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8215 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8216 if (isError) 8217 return QualType(); 8218 } 8219 8220 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) 8221 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 8222 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 8223 else 8224 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 8225 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 8226 return ResultTy; 8227 } 8228 8229 // Handle block pointers. 8230 if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull 8231 && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8232 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 8233 return ResultTy; 8234 } 8235 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull 8236 && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 8237 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 8238 return ResultTy; 8239 } 8240 8241 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8242 } 8243 8244 8245 // Return a signed type that is of identical size and number of elements. 8246 // For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical size 8247 // and number of elements. 8248 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) { 8249 const VectorType *VTy = V->getAs<VectorType>(); 8250 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType()); 8251 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy)) 8252 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8253 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy)) 8254 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8255 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy)) 8256 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8257 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy)) 8258 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8259 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) && 8260 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare"); 8261 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 8262 } 8263 8264 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that 8265 /// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result, 8266 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer 8267 /// types. 8268 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8269 SourceLocation Loc, 8270 bool IsRelational) { 8271 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width, 8272 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type. 8273 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false); 8274 if (vType.isNull()) 8275 return vType; 8276 8277 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 8278 8279 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e. 8280 // bool for C++, int for C 8281 if (vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) 8282 return Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 8283 8284 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 8285 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 8286 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 8287 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() && 8288 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 8289 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL 8290 = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) 8291 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR 8292 = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) 8293 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl()) 8294 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 8295 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 8296 << 0 // self- 8297 << 2 // "a constant" 8298 ); 8299 } 8300 8301 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 8302 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) { 8303 assert (RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation()); 8304 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 8305 } 8306 8307 // Return a signed type for the vector. 8308 return GetSignedVectorType(LHSType); 8309 } 8310 8311 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8312 SourceLocation Loc) { 8313 // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or 8314 // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type. 8315 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false); 8316 if (vType.isNull()) 8317 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8318 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 && 8319 vType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 8320 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8321 8322 return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType()); 8323 } 8324 8325 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands( 8326 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 8327 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false); 8328 8329 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 8330 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 8331 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 8332 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 8333 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 8334 8335 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8336 } 8337 8338 ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS; 8339 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult, 8340 IsCompAssign); 8341 if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid()) 8342 return QualType(); 8343 LHS = LHSResult.get(); 8344 RHS = RHSResult.get(); 8345 8346 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 8347 return compType; 8348 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8349 } 8350 8351 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14] 8352 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) { 8353 8354 // Check vector operands differently. 8355 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 8356 return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc); 8357 8358 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a 8359 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS 8360 // is a constant. 8361 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && 8362 !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 8363 RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 8364 // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations. 8365 !Loc.isMacroID() && ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) { 8366 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something 8367 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that 8368 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn. 8369 // Parens on the RHS are ignored. 8370 llvm::APSInt Result; 8371 if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) 8372 if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 8373 !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) || 8374 (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) { 8375 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise) 8376 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8377 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||"); 8378 // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version 8379 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator) 8380 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|") 8381 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange( 8382 Loc, Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(Loc, 0, getSourceManager(), 8383 getLangOpts())), 8384 Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|"); 8385 if (Opc == BO_LAnd) 8386 // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()" 8387 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant) 8388 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 8389 SourceRange( 8390 Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getLocEnd(), 8391 0, getSourceManager(), 8392 getLangOpts()), 8393 RHS.get()->getLocEnd())); 8394 } 8395 } 8396 8397 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8398 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do 8399 // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types. 8400 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 8401 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 8402 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() || 8403 RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType()) 8404 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8405 } 8406 8407 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 8408 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 8409 return QualType(); 8410 8411 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 8412 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8413 return QualType(); 8414 8415 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() || 8416 !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) 8417 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8418 8419 return Context.IntTy; 8420 } 8421 8422 // The following is safe because we only use this method for 8423 // non-overloadable operands. 8424 8425 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1 8426 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1 8427 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool. 8428 ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get()); 8429 if (LHSRes.isInvalid()) 8430 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8431 LHS = LHSRes; 8432 8433 ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get()); 8434 if (RHSRes.isInvalid()) 8435 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8436 RHS = RHSRes; 8437 8438 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2 8439 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2 8440 // The result is a bool. 8441 return Context.BoolTy; 8442 } 8443 8444 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) { 8445 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 8446 if (!ME) return false; 8447 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false; 8448 ObjCMessageExpr *Base = 8449 dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 8450 if (!Base) return false; 8451 return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr; 8452 } 8453 8454 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a 8455 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become 8456 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block? 8457 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda }; 8458 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 8459 assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified()); 8460 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 8461 8462 // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope. 8463 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 8464 if (!DRE) return NCCK_None; 8465 if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingLocal()) return NCCK_None; 8466 8467 // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'. 8468 VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 8469 if (!var) return NCCK_None; 8470 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None; 8471 assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?"); 8472 8473 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda. 8474 DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr; 8475 while (DC != var->getDeclContext()) { 8476 Prev = DC; 8477 DC = DC->getParent(); 8478 } 8479 // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far. 8480 if (!var->isInitCapture()) 8481 DC = Prev; 8482 return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda); 8483 } 8484 8485 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not, 8486 /// emit an error and return true. If so, return false. 8487 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) { 8488 assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 8489 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc; 8490 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context, 8491 &Loc); 8492 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S)) 8493 IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression; 8494 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid) 8495 return false; 8496 8497 unsigned Diag = 0; 8498 bool NeedType = false; 8499 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2 8500 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: 8501 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; 8502 8503 // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object 8504 // from an enclosing function or block. 8505 if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) { 8506 if (NCCK == NCCK_Block) 8507 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8508 else 8509 Diag = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8510 break; 8511 } 8512 8513 // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we 8514 // infer 'const'. These are always pseudo-strong variables. 8515 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 8516 DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()); 8517 if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) { 8518 VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl()); 8519 8520 // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the 8521 // user actually wrote 'const'. 8522 if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() && 8523 (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() || 8524 !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) { 8525 // There are two pseudo-strong cases: 8526 // - self 8527 ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl(); 8528 if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl()) 8529 Diag = method->isClassMethod() 8530 ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method 8531 : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self; 8532 8533 // - fast enumeration variables 8534 else 8535 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration; 8536 8537 SourceRange Assign; 8538 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 8539 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 8540 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 8541 // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool 8542 // can do its job. 8543 return false; 8544 } 8545 } 8546 } 8547 8548 break; 8549 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType: 8550 case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary: 8551 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8552 NeedType = true; 8553 break; 8554 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType: 8555 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8556 NeedType = true; 8557 break; 8558 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast: 8559 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported; 8560 break; 8561 case Expr::MLV_Valid: 8562 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid"); 8563 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression: 8564 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction: 8565 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary: 8566 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue; 8567 break; 8568 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType: 8569 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType: 8570 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(), 8571 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E); 8572 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents: 8573 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue; 8574 break; 8575 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty: 8576 llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently"); 8577 case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression: 8578 Diag = diag::error_readonly_message_assignment; 8579 break; 8580 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting: 8581 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting; 8582 break; 8583 } 8584 8585 SourceRange Assign; 8586 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 8587 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 8588 if (NeedType) 8589 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 8590 else 8591 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 8592 return true; 8593 } 8594 8595 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 8596 SourceLocation Loc, 8597 Sema &Sema) { 8598 // C / C++ fields 8599 MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr); 8600 MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr); 8601 if (ML && MR && ML->getMemberDecl() == MR->getMemberDecl()) { 8602 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase())) 8603 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0; 8604 } 8605 8606 // Objective-C instance variables 8607 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 8608 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 8609 if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) { 8610 DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8611 DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 8612 if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl()) 8613 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1; 8614 } 8615 } 8616 8617 // C99 6.5.16.1 8618 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS, 8619 SourceLocation Loc, 8620 QualType CompoundType) { 8621 assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 8622 8623 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not. 8624 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this)) 8625 return QualType(); 8626 8627 QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType(); 8628 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() : 8629 CompoundType; 8630 AssignConvertType ConvTy; 8631 if (CompoundType.isNull()) { 8632 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get(); 8633 8634 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this); 8635 8636 QualType LHSTy(LHSType); 8637 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS); 8638 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8639 return QualType(); 8640 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types. 8641 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer && 8642 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) && 8643 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) || 8644 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) && 8645 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) 8646 ConvTy = Compatible; 8647 8648 if (ConvTy == Compatible && 8649 LHSType->isObjCObjectType()) 8650 Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment) 8651 << LHSType; 8652 8653 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are 8654 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4" 8655 // instead of "x += 4". 8656 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck)) 8657 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr(); 8658 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) { 8659 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus || 8660 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) && 8661 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() && 8662 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent. 8663 Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() && 8664 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the 8665 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1". 8666 Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() && 8667 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) { 8668 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign) 8669 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-") 8670 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc()); 8671 } 8672 } 8673 8674 if (ConvTy == Compatible) { 8675 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) { 8676 // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but 8677 // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is 8678 // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference! 8679 const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 8680 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS); 8681 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 8682 checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 8683 8684 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 8685 // Although this code can still have problems: 8686 // id x = self.weakProp; 8687 // id y = self.weakProp; 8688 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 8689 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 8690 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 8691 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 8692 RHS.get()->getLocStart())) 8693 getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get()); 8694 8695 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 8696 checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 8697 } 8698 } 8699 } else { 8700 // Compound assignment "x += y" 8701 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType); 8702 } 8703 8704 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType, 8705 RHS.get(), AA_Assigning)) 8706 return QualType(); 8707 8708 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr); 8709 8710 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the 8711 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case 8712 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand. 8713 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand 8714 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above). 8715 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left 8716 // operand. 8717 return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 8718 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType()); 8719 } 8720 8721 // C99 6.5.17 8722 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8723 SourceLocation Loc) { 8724 LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 8725 RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 8726 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 8727 return QualType(); 8728 8729 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its 8730 // operands, but not unary promotions. 8731 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1). 8732 8733 // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the 8734 // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS. 8735 LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get()); 8736 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 8737 return QualType(); 8738 8739 S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get()); 8740 8741 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8742 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 8743 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8744 return QualType(); 8745 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType()) 8746 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(), 8747 diag::err_incomplete_type); 8748 } 8749 8750 return RHS.get()->getType(); 8751 } 8752 8753 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine 8754 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions. 8755 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, 8756 ExprValueKind &VK, 8757 SourceLocation OpLoc, 8758 bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) { 8759 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 8760 return S.Context.DependentTy; 8761 8762 QualType ResType = Op->getType(); 8763 // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic 8764 // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of 8765 // checking. 8766 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 8767 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 8768 8769 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression"); 8770 8771 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) { 8772 // Decrement of bool is not allowed. 8773 if (!IsInc) { 8774 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange(); 8775 return QualType(); 8776 } 8777 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated. 8778 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange(); 8779 } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) { 8780 // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode 8781 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType; 8782 return QualType(); 8783 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) { 8784 // OK! 8785 } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) { 8786 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2 8787 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op)) 8788 return QualType(); 8789 } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8790 // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden. 8791 // Otherwise, we just need a complete type. 8792 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) || 8793 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op)) 8794 return QualType(); 8795 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) { 8796 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension. 8797 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex) 8798 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange(); 8799 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) { 8800 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 8801 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 8802 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc, 8803 IsInc, IsPrefix); 8804 } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) { 8805 // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 ) 8806 } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() && 8807 ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) { 8808 // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types. 8809 } else { 8810 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement) 8811 << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange(); 8812 return QualType(); 8813 } 8814 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type. 8815 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue. 8816 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S)) 8817 return QualType(); 8818 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise 8819 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the 8820 // operand. 8821 if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8822 VK = VK_LValue; 8823 return ResType; 8824 } else { 8825 VK = VK_RValue; 8826 return ResType.getUnqualifiedType(); 8827 } 8828 } 8829 8830 8831 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand(). 8832 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions 8833 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to 8834 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator 8835 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples: 8836 /// - &(x) => x 8837 /// - &*****f => f for f a function designator. 8838 /// - &s.xx => s 8839 /// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array 8840 /// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array 8841 /// - &"123"[2] -> 0 8842 /// - & __real__ x -> x 8843 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) { 8844 switch (E->getStmtClass()) { 8845 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass: 8846 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl(); 8847 case Stmt::MemberExprClass: 8848 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from 8849 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is 8850 // irrelevant. 8851 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow()) 8852 return nullptr; 8853 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base 8854 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase()); 8855 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: { 8856 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit 8857 // promotion of register arrays earlier. 8858 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase(); 8859 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) { 8860 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType()) 8861 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr()); 8862 } 8863 return nullptr; 8864 } 8865 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: { 8866 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E); 8867 8868 switch(UO->getOpcode()) { 8869 case UO_Real: 8870 case UO_Imag: 8871 case UO_Extension: 8872 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr()); 8873 default: 8874 return nullptr; 8875 } 8876 } 8877 case Stmt::ParenExprClass: 8878 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 8879 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: 8880 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about 8881 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter. 8882 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 8883 default: 8884 return nullptr; 8885 } 8886 } 8887 8888 namespace { 8889 enum { 8890 AO_Bit_Field = 0, 8891 AO_Vector_Element = 1, 8892 AO_Property_Expansion = 2, 8893 AO_Register_Variable = 3, 8894 AO_No_Error = 4 8895 }; 8896 } 8897 /// \brief Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations. 8898 /// 8899 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken. 8900 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 8901 Expr *E, unsigned Type) { 8902 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange(); 8903 } 8904 8905 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function 8906 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the 8907 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field. 8908 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the & 8909 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue. 8910 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case 8911 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type. 8912 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 8913 if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){ 8914 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 8915 Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 8916 if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) { 8917 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf); 8918 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function) 8919 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 8920 return QualType(); 8921 } 8922 8923 OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E); 8924 if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl)) 8925 if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) { 8926 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 8927 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 8928 return QualType(); 8929 } 8930 8931 return Context.OverloadTy; 8932 } 8933 8934 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny) 8935 return Context.UnknownAnyTy; 8936 8937 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) { 8938 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 8939 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 8940 return QualType(); 8941 } 8942 8943 OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get()); 8944 if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 8945 } 8946 8947 if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent()) 8948 return Context.DependentTy; 8949 8950 assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType()); 8951 8952 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks 8953 Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 8954 8955 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed. 8956 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && op->getType()->isFunctionType()) { 8957 Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address); 8958 return QualType(); 8959 } 8960 8961 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 8962 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules. 8963 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) { 8964 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref) 8965 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result 8966 // (assuming the deref expression is valid). 8967 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType(); 8968 } 8969 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript 8970 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway. 8971 } 8972 ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op); 8973 Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context); 8974 unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error; 8975 8976 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) { 8977 bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext(); 8978 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary 8979 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary) 8980 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 8981 if (sfinae) 8982 return QualType(); 8983 // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address. 8984 OrigOp = op = new (Context) 8985 MaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true); 8986 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) { 8987 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 8988 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) { 8989 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer. 8990 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo. 8991 8992 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up. 8993 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) { 8994 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 8995 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 8996 return QualType(); 8997 } 8998 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op); 8999 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 9000 9001 // The id-expression was parenthesized. 9002 if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) { 9003 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function) 9004 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 9005 9006 // The method was named without a qualifier. 9007 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) { 9008 if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty()) 9009 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 9010 << op->getSourceRange(); 9011 else { 9012 SmallString<32> Str; 9013 StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str); 9014 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 9015 << op->getSourceRange() 9016 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual); 9017 } 9018 } 9019 9020 // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2. 9021 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) 9022 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange(); 9023 9024 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 9025 op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr()); 9026 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 9027 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0); 9028 return MPTy; 9029 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 9030 // C99 6.5.3.2p1 9031 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator 9032 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) { 9033 // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references. 9034 if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) { 9035 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 9036 } else { 9037 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof) 9038 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 9039 return QualType(); 9040 } 9041 } 9042 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 9043 // The operand cannot be a bit-field 9044 AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field; 9045 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) { 9046 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector 9047 AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element; 9048 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 9049 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared 9050 // with the register storage-class specifier. 9051 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) { 9052 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register 9053 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3) 9054 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register && 9055 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9056 AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable; 9057 } 9058 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 9059 return Context.OverloadTy; 9060 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) { 9061 // Okay: we can take the address of a field. 9062 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit 9063 // scope qualifier for the class. 9064 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) { 9065 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext(); 9066 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) { 9067 if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 9068 Diag(OpLoc, 9069 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type) 9070 << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType(); 9071 return QualType(); 9072 } 9073 9074 while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 9075 Ctx = Ctx->getParent(); 9076 9077 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 9078 op->getType(), 9079 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr()); 9080 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 9081 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0); 9082 return MPTy; 9083 } 9084 } 9085 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl)) 9086 llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type"); 9087 } 9088 9089 if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) { 9090 diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError); 9091 return QualType(); 9092 } 9093 9094 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 9095 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we 9096 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid. 9097 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;". 9098 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange(); 9099 } 9100 9101 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type". 9102 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType()) 9103 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType()); 9104 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 9105 } 9106 9107 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*'). 9108 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK, 9109 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9110 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 9111 return S.Context.DependentTy; 9112 9113 ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op); 9114 if (ConvResult.isInvalid()) 9115 return QualType(); 9116 Op = ConvResult.get(); 9117 QualType OpTy = Op->getType(); 9118 QualType Result; 9119 9120 if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) { 9121 QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType(); 9122 S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true, 9123 Op->getSourceRange()); 9124 } 9125 9126 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 9127 Result = PT->getPointeeType(); 9128 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = 9129 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 9130 Result = OPT->getPointeeType(); 9131 else { 9132 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 9133 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9134 if (PR.get() != Op) 9135 return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc); 9136 } 9137 9138 if (Result.isNull()) { 9139 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer) 9140 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 9141 return QualType(); 9142 } 9143 9144 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result 9145 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about 9146 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a 9147 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid 9148 // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type: 9149 // 9150 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1: 9151 // [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall 9152 // be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type 9153 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType()) 9154 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer) 9155 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 9156 9157 // Dereferences are usually l-values... 9158 VK = VK_LValue; 9159 9160 // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C. 9161 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType()) 9162 VK = VK_RValue; 9163 9164 return Result; 9165 } 9166 9167 static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode( 9168 tok::TokenKind Kind) { 9169 BinaryOperatorKind Opc; 9170 switch (Kind) { 9171 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!"); 9172 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break; 9173 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break; 9174 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break; 9175 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break; 9176 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break; 9177 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break; 9178 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break; 9179 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break; 9180 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break; 9181 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break; 9182 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break; 9183 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break; 9184 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break; 9185 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break; 9186 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break; 9187 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break; 9188 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break; 9189 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break; 9190 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break; 9191 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break; 9192 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break; 9193 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break; 9194 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break; 9195 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break; 9196 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break; 9197 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break; 9198 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break; 9199 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break; 9200 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break; 9201 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break; 9202 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break; 9203 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break; 9204 } 9205 return Opc; 9206 } 9207 9208 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode( 9209 tok::TokenKind Kind) { 9210 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 9211 switch (Kind) { 9212 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 9213 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break; 9214 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break; 9215 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break; 9216 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break; 9217 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break; 9218 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break; 9219 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break; 9220 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break; 9221 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break; 9222 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break; 9223 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break; 9224 } 9225 return Opc; 9226 } 9227 9228 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself. 9229 /// This warning is only emitted for builtin assignment operations. It is also 9230 /// suppressed in the event of macro expansions. 9231 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 9232 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9233 if (!S.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) 9234 return; 9235 if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID()) 9236 return; 9237 LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9238 RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9239 const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 9240 const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 9241 if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef || 9242 LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() || 9243 RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID()) 9244 return; 9245 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl = 9246 cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 9247 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl = 9248 cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 9249 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl) 9250 return; 9251 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 9252 return; 9253 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 9254 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified()) 9255 return; 9256 9257 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_self_assignment) 9258 << LHSDeclRef->getType() 9259 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9260 } 9261 9262 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer. This 9263 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer. 9264 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R, 9265 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 9266 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1) 9267 return; 9268 9269 const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr; 9270 const Expr *LHS = L.get(); 9271 const Expr *RHS = R.get(); 9272 9273 if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9274 ObjCPointerExpr = LHS; 9275 OtherExpr = RHS; 9276 } 9277 else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9278 ObjCPointerExpr = RHS; 9279 OtherExpr = LHS; 9280 } 9281 9282 // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false 9283 // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing. This logic mainly 9284 // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which 9285 // code should generally never do. 9286 if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 9287 unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking; 9288 // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX. 9289 const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 9290 // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which 9291 // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value. 9292 // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase. 9293 if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) { 9294 Selector S = ME->getSelector(); 9295 StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0); 9296 if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector")) 9297 Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector; 9298 } 9299 9300 S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag) 9301 << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 9302 } 9303 } 9304 9305 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with 9306 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports 9307 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators. 9308 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 9309 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9310 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9311 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) { 9312 // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment, 9313 // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for 9314 // non-assignment operators. 9315 // C++11 5.17p9: 9316 // The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning 9317 // of x = {} is x = T(). 9318 InitializationKind Kind = 9319 InitializationKind::CreateDirectList(RHSExpr->getLocStart()); 9320 InitializedEntity Entity = 9321 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType()); 9322 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 9323 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 9324 if (Init.isInvalid()) 9325 return Init; 9326 RHSExpr = Init.get(); 9327 } 9328 9329 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 9330 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator. 9331 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators 9332 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation 9333 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result 9334 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 9335 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 9336 9337 switch (Opc) { 9338 case BO_Assign: 9339 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType()); 9340 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 9341 LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) { 9342 VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind(); 9343 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 9344 } 9345 if (!ResultTy.isNull()) 9346 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 9347 break; 9348 case BO_PtrMemD: 9349 case BO_PtrMemI: 9350 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc, 9351 Opc == BO_PtrMemI); 9352 break; 9353 case BO_Mul: 9354 case BO_Div: 9355 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false, 9356 Opc == BO_Div); 9357 break; 9358 case BO_Rem: 9359 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9360 break; 9361 case BO_Add: 9362 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 9363 break; 9364 case BO_Sub: 9365 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9366 break; 9367 case BO_Shl: 9368 case BO_Shr: 9369 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 9370 break; 9371 case BO_LE: 9372 case BO_LT: 9373 case BO_GE: 9374 case BO_GT: 9375 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true); 9376 break; 9377 case BO_EQ: 9378 case BO_NE: 9379 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, false); 9380 break; 9381 case BO_And: 9382 checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9383 case BO_Xor: 9384 case BO_Or: 9385 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9386 break; 9387 case BO_LAnd: 9388 case BO_LOr: 9389 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 9390 break; 9391 case BO_MulAssign: 9392 case BO_DivAssign: 9393 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true, 9394 Opc == BO_DivAssign); 9395 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 9396 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9397 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9398 break; 9399 case BO_RemAssign: 9400 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true); 9401 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 9402 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9403 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9404 break; 9405 case BO_AddAssign: 9406 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy); 9407 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9408 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9409 break; 9410 case BO_SubAssign: 9411 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy); 9412 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9413 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9414 break; 9415 case BO_ShlAssign: 9416 case BO_ShrAssign: 9417 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true); 9418 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 9419 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9420 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9421 break; 9422 case BO_AndAssign: 9423 case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough 9424 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 9425 case BO_XorAssign: 9426 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true); 9427 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 9428 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 9429 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 9430 break; 9431 case BO_Comma: 9432 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 9433 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) { 9434 VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind(); 9435 OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 9436 } 9437 break; 9438 } 9439 if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9440 return ExprError(); 9441 9442 // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator 9443 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get()); 9444 CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get()); 9445 9446 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 9447 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 9448 &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 9449 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 9450 if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) { 9451 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd()); 9452 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) << 9453 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") << 9454 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc), ",") << 9455 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 9456 } 9457 else 9458 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 9459 } 9460 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 9461 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) 9462 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get()); 9463 9464 if (CompResultTy.isNull()) 9465 return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, 9466 OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract); 9467 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != 9468 OK_ObjCProperty) { 9469 VK = VK_LValue; 9470 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 9471 } 9472 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 9473 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy, 9474 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract); 9475 } 9476 9477 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison 9478 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that 9479 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of 9480 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1". 9481 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9482 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 9483 Expr *RHSExpr) { 9484 BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr); 9485 BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr); 9486 9487 // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator. 9488 bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 9489 bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 9490 if (!isLeftComp && !isRightComp) 9491 return; 9492 9493 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops. 9494 // Don't diagnose this. 9495 bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 9496 bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 9497 if ((isLeftComp || isLeftBitwise) && (isRightComp || isRightBitwise)) 9498 return; 9499 9500 SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), 9501 OpLoc) 9502 : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getLocEnd()); 9503 StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr(); 9504 SourceRange ParensRange = isLeftComp ? 9505 SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()) 9506 : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getLocStart()); 9507 9508 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel) 9509 << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr; 9510 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 9511 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr, 9512 (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange()); 9513 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 9514 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first) 9515 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 9516 ParensRange); 9517 } 9518 9519 /// \brief It accepts a '&' expr that is inside a '|' one. 9520 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&' expression 9521 /// in parentheses. 9522 static void 9523 EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9524 BinaryOperator *Bop) { 9525 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And); 9526 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_and_in_bitwise_or) 9527 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 9528 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 9529 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 9530 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 9531 Bop->getSourceRange()); 9532 } 9533 9534 /// \brief It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one. 9535 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression 9536 /// in parentheses. 9537 static void 9538 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9539 BinaryOperator *Bop) { 9540 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd); 9541 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or) 9542 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 9543 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 9544 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 9545 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 9546 Bop->getSourceRange()); 9547 } 9548 9549 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 9550 /// 'true'. 9551 static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 9552 bool Res; 9553 return !E->isValueDependent() && 9554 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res; 9555 } 9556 9557 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 9558 /// 'false'. 9559 static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 9560 bool Res; 9561 return !E->isValueDependent() && 9562 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res; 9563 } 9564 9565 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr. 9566 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9567 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9568 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) { 9569 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 9570 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 9571 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr)) 9572 return; 9573 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 9574 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS())) 9575 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 9576 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) { 9577 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) { 9578 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for 9579 // "a || b && 1", but warn now. 9580 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS())) 9581 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop); 9582 } 9583 } 9584 } 9585 } 9586 9587 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr. 9588 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9589 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9590 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) { 9591 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 9592 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 9593 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr)) 9594 return; 9595 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 9596 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS())) 9597 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 9598 } 9599 } 9600 } 9601 9602 /// \brief Look for '&' in the left or right hand of a '|' expr. 9603 static void DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9604 Expr *OrArg) { 9605 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrArg)) { 9606 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And) 9607 return EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 9608 } 9609 } 9610 9611 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9612 Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) { 9613 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) { 9614 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) { 9615 StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr(); 9616 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift) 9617 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op; 9618 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 9619 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op, 9620 Bop->getSourceRange()); 9621 } 9622 } 9623 } 9624 9625 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9626 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9627 CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr); 9628 if (!OCE) 9629 return; 9630 9631 FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee(); 9632 if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator()) 9633 return; 9634 9635 OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator(); 9636 if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater) 9637 return; 9638 9639 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison) 9640 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange() 9641 << (Kind == OO_LessLess); 9642 SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(), 9643 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 9644 << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"), 9645 OCE->getSourceRange()); 9646 SuggestParentheses(S, OpLoc, 9647 S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first), 9648 SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getLocStart(), 9649 RHSExpr->getLocEnd())); 9650 } 9651 9652 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky 9653 /// precedence. 9654 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9655 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 9656 Expr *RHSExpr){ 9657 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3". 9658 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc)) 9659 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9660 9661 // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3" 9662 if (Opc == BO_Or && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 9663 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr); 9664 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr); 9665 } 9666 9667 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does. 9668 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe. 9669 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 9670 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9671 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9672 } 9673 9674 if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext())) 9675 || Opc == BO_Shr) { 9676 StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 9677 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift); 9678 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift); 9679 } 9680 9681 // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as: 9682 // cout << 5 == 4; 9683 if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc)) 9684 DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9685 } 9686 9687 // Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 9688 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 9689 tok::TokenKind Kind, 9690 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9691 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind); 9692 assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression"); 9693 assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression"); 9694 9695 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0" 9696 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9697 9698 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9699 } 9700 9701 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope. 9702 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9703 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9704 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 9705 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 9706 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 9707 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 9708 // the arguments. 9709 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 9710 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp 9711 = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 9712 if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None) 9713 S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(), 9714 RHS->getType(), Functions); 9715 9716 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent) 9717 // binary operation. 9718 return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS); 9719 } 9720 9721 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9722 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9723 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9724 // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment 9725 // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if 9726 // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent), 9727 // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case). We also want to get 9728 // any placeholder types out of the way. 9729 9730 // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS. 9731 if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 9732 // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis. 9733 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 9734 BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) 9735 return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9736 9737 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 9738 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 9739 // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder, 9740 // though. Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that 9741 // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set. Note 9742 // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never 9743 // instantiates to having an overloadable type. 9744 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 9745 if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 9746 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 9747 9748 if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || 9749 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 9750 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9751 } 9752 9753 ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr); 9754 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 9755 LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 9756 } 9757 9758 // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS. 9759 if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 9760 // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type 9761 // being assigned to. 9762 if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 9763 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) 9764 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9765 9766 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 9767 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9768 9769 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9770 } 9771 9772 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 9773 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload && 9774 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 9775 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9776 9777 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 9778 if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 9779 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 9780 } 9781 9782 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9783 // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an 9784 // overloaded op. 9785 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) 9786 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9787 9788 // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an 9789 // overloadable type. 9790 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() || 9791 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 9792 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9793 } 9794 9795 // Build a built-in binary operation. 9796 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9797 } 9798 9799 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 9800 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 9801 Expr *InputExpr) { 9802 ExprResult Input = InputExpr; 9803 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 9804 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 9805 QualType resultType; 9806 switch (Opc) { 9807 case UO_PreInc: 9808 case UO_PreDec: 9809 case UO_PostInc: 9810 case UO_PostDec: 9811 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc, 9812 Opc == UO_PreInc || 9813 Opc == UO_PostInc, 9814 Opc == UO_PreInc || 9815 Opc == UO_PreDec); 9816 break; 9817 case UO_AddrOf: 9818 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc); 9819 break; 9820 case UO_Deref: { 9821 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 9822 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 9823 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc); 9824 break; 9825 } 9826 case UO_Plus: 9827 case UO_Minus: 9828 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 9829 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 9830 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 9831 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 9832 break; 9833 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1 9834 resultType->isVectorType()) 9835 break; 9836 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6 9837 Opc == UO_Plus && 9838 resultType->isPointerType()) 9839 break; 9840 9841 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 9842 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 9843 9844 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement 9845 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 9846 if (Input.isInvalid()) 9847 return ExprError(); 9848 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 9849 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 9850 break; 9851 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension. 9852 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType()) 9853 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation. 9854 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex) 9855 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange(); 9856 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 9857 break; 9858 else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) { 9859 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 9860 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate 9861 // on vector float types. 9862 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 9863 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 9864 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 9865 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 9866 } 9867 break; 9868 } else { 9869 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 9870 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 9871 } 9872 break; 9873 9874 case UO_LNot: // logical negation 9875 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5). 9876 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 9877 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 9878 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 9879 9880 // Though we still have to promote half FP to float... 9881 if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) { 9882 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 9883 resultType = Context.FloatTy; 9884 } 9885 9886 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 9887 break; 9888 if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) { 9889 // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough; 9890 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9891 // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9: 9892 // operand contextually converted to bool. 9893 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy, 9894 ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType)); 9895 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 9896 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 9897 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 9898 // operate on scalar float types. 9899 if (!resultType->isIntegerType()) 9900 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 9901 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 9902 } 9903 } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) { 9904 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 9905 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 9906 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 9907 // operate on vector float types. 9908 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 9909 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 9910 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 9911 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 9912 } 9913 // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type. 9914 resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType); 9915 break; 9916 } else { 9917 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 9918 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 9919 } 9920 9921 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5. 9922 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8 9923 resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 9924 break; 9925 case UO_Real: 9926 case UO_Imag: 9927 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real); 9928 // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary 9929 // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values. 9930 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 9931 if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) { 9932 if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue && 9933 Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary) 9934 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 9935 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9936 // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not. 9937 Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 9938 } 9939 break; 9940 case UO_Extension: 9941 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 9942 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 9943 OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind(); 9944 break; 9945 } 9946 if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid()) 9947 return ExprError(); 9948 9949 // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator, 9950 // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially 9951 // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize] 9952 // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard). 9953 if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref) 9954 CheckArrayAccess(Input.get()); 9955 9956 return new (Context) 9957 UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc); 9958 } 9959 9960 /// \brief Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member 9961 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member 9962 /// with the address-of operator. 9963 static bool isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) { 9964 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 9965 if (!DRE->getQualifier()) 9966 return false; 9967 9968 ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl(); 9969 if (!VD->isCXXClassMember()) 9970 return false; 9971 9972 if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 9973 return true; 9974 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)) 9975 return Method->isInstance(); 9976 9977 return false; 9978 } 9979 9980 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 9981 if (!ULE->getQualifier()) 9982 return false; 9983 9984 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator D = ULE->decls_begin(), 9985 DEnd = ULE->decls_end(); 9986 D != DEnd; ++D) { 9987 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(*D)) { 9988 if (Method->isInstance()) 9989 return true; 9990 } else { 9991 // Overload set does not contain methods. 9992 break; 9993 } 9994 } 9995 9996 return false; 9997 } 9998 9999 return false; 10000 } 10001 10002 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10003 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) { 10004 // First things first: handle placeholders so that the 10005 // overloaded-operator check considers the right type. 10006 if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 10007 // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references. 10008 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 10009 UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc)) 10010 return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10011 10012 // extension is always a builtin operator. 10013 if (Opc == UO_Extension) 10014 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10015 10016 // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder. 10017 // The builtin code knows what to do. 10018 if (Opc == UO_AddrOf && 10019 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload || 10020 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny || 10021 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember)) 10022 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10023 10024 // Anything else needs to be handled now. 10025 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input); 10026 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 10027 Input = Result.get(); 10028 } 10029 10030 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() && 10031 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None && 10032 !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) { 10033 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 10034 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 10035 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 10036 // the arguments. 10037 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 10038 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 10039 if (S && OverOp != OO_None) 10040 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(), 10041 Functions); 10042 10043 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input); 10044 } 10045 10046 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 10047 } 10048 10049 // Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 10050 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 10051 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) { 10052 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input); 10053 } 10054 10055 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo". 10056 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc, 10057 LabelDecl *TheDecl) { 10058 TheDecl->markUsed(Context); 10059 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'. 10060 return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl, 10061 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)); 10062 } 10063 10064 /// Given the last statement in a statement-expression, check whether 10065 /// the result is a producing expression (like a call to an 10066 /// ns_returns_retained function) and, if so, rebuild it to hoist the 10067 /// release out of the full-expression. Otherwise, return null. 10068 /// Cannot fail. 10069 static Expr *maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(Stmt *Statement) { 10070 // Should always be wrapped with one of these. 10071 ExprWithCleanups *cleanups = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Statement); 10072 if (!cleanups) return nullptr; 10073 10074 ImplicitCastExpr *cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(cleanups->getSubExpr()); 10075 if (!cast || cast->getCastKind() != CK_ARCConsumeObject) 10076 return nullptr; 10077 10078 // Splice out the cast. This shouldn't modify any interesting 10079 // features of the statement. 10080 Expr *producer = cast->getSubExpr(); 10081 assert(producer->getType() == cast->getType()); 10082 assert(producer->getValueKind() == cast->getValueKind()); 10083 cleanups->setSubExpr(producer); 10084 return cleanups; 10085 } 10086 10087 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() { 10088 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 10089 } 10090 10091 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() { 10092 // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a 10093 // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything. 10094 10095 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10096 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10097 } 10098 10099 ExprResult 10100 Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt, 10101 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})" 10102 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!"); 10103 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt); 10104 10105 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 10106 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10107 assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!"); 10108 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10109 10110 bool isFileScope 10111 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == nullptr) && (getCurBlock() == nullptr); 10112 if (isFileScope) 10113 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope)); 10114 10115 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for 10116 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently. 10117 // More semantic analysis is needed. 10118 10119 // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one 10120 // as the type of the stmtexpr. 10121 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy; 10122 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false; 10123 if (!Compound->body_empty()) { 10124 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back(); 10125 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = nullptr; 10126 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body. 10127 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) { 10128 LastLabelStmt = Label; 10129 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt(); 10130 } 10131 10132 if (Expr *LastE = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) { 10133 // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not 10134 // lvalue-to-rvalue. However, initialize an unqualified type. 10135 ExprResult LastExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(LastE); 10136 if (LastExpr.isInvalid()) 10137 return ExprError(); 10138 Ty = LastExpr.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 10139 10140 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr.get()->isTypeDependent()) { 10141 // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice 10142 // the consume out and bind it later. In the alternate case 10143 // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result 10144 // initialization will create a produce. In both cases the 10145 // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with 10146 // a bind. 10147 if (Expr *rebuiltLastStmt 10148 = maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(LastExpr.get())) { 10149 LastExpr = rebuiltLastStmt; 10150 } else { 10151 LastExpr = PerformCopyInitialization( 10152 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc, 10153 Ty, 10154 false), 10155 SourceLocation(), 10156 LastExpr); 10157 } 10158 10159 if (LastExpr.isInvalid()) 10160 return ExprError(); 10161 if (LastExpr.get() != nullptr) { 10162 if (!LastLabelStmt) 10163 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr.get()); 10164 else 10165 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr.get()); 10166 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true; 10167 } 10168 } 10169 } 10170 } 10171 10172 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement 10173 // expressions are not lvalues. 10174 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc); 10175 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp) 10176 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr); 10177 return ResStmtExpr; 10178 } 10179 10180 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 10181 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 10182 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr, 10183 unsigned NumComponents, 10184 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 10185 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType(); 10186 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType(); 10187 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange(); 10188 10189 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first 10190 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents 10191 // a struct/union/class. 10192 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType()) 10193 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 10194 << ArgTy << TypeRange); 10195 10196 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable 10197 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed. 10198 if (!Dependent 10199 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy, 10200 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange)) 10201 return ExprError(); 10202 10203 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a 10204 // GCC extension, diagnose them. 10205 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in 10206 // a system header! 10207 if (NumComponents != 1) 10208 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator) 10209 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd); 10210 10211 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false; 10212 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy; 10213 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode; 10214 SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps; 10215 SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs; 10216 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) { 10217 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i]; 10218 if (OC.isBrackets) { 10219 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements? 10220 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 10221 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType); 10222 if(!AT) 10223 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type) 10224 << CurrentType); 10225 CurrentType = AT->getElementType(); 10226 } else 10227 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 10228 10229 ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E)); 10230 if (IdxRval.isInvalid()) 10231 return ExprError(); 10232 Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get(); 10233 10234 // The expression must be an integral expression. 10235 // FIXME: An integral constant expression? 10236 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() && 10237 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType()) 10238 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(), 10239 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 10240 << Idx->getSourceRange()); 10241 10242 // Record this array index. 10243 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd)); 10244 Exprs.push_back(Idx); 10245 continue; 10246 } 10247 10248 // Offset of a field. 10249 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 10250 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent 10251 // type. Just record the identifier of the field. 10252 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd)); 10253 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 10254 continue; 10255 } 10256 10257 // We need to have a complete type to look into. 10258 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, 10259 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)) 10260 return ExprError(); 10261 10262 // Look for the designated field. 10263 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>(); 10264 if (!RC) 10265 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 10266 << CurrentType); 10267 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl(); 10268 10269 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5: 10270 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this 10271 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union 10272 // (clause 9). 10273 // C++11 [support.types]p4: 10274 // If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are 10275 // undefined. 10276 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 10277 bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD(); 10278 unsigned DiagID = 10279 LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::warn_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type 10280 : diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type; 10281 10282 if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD && 10283 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr, 10284 PDiag(DiagID) 10285 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd) 10286 << CurrentType)) 10287 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true; 10288 } 10289 10290 // Look for the field. 10291 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName); 10292 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD); 10293 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>(); 10294 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr; 10295 if (!MemberDecl) { 10296 if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>())) 10297 MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField(); 10298 } 10299 10300 if (!MemberDecl) 10301 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member) 10302 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, 10303 OC.LocEnd)); 10304 10305 // C99 7.17p3: 10306 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.) 10307 // 10308 // We diagnose this as an error. 10309 if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) { 10310 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield) 10311 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 10312 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 10313 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl); 10314 return ExprError(); 10315 } 10316 10317 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent(); 10318 if (IndirectMemberDecl) 10319 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext()); 10320 10321 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for 10322 // the base class indirections. 10323 CXXBasePaths Paths; 10324 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) { 10325 if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 10326 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base) 10327 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 10328 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 10329 return ExprError(); 10330 } 10331 10332 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front(); 10333 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end(); 10334 B != BEnd; ++B) 10335 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base)); 10336 } 10337 10338 if (IndirectMemberDecl) { 10339 for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) { 10340 assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI)); 10341 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, 10342 cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd)); 10343 } 10344 } else 10345 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd)); 10346 10347 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType(); 10348 } 10349 10350 return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo, 10351 Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc); 10352 } 10353 10354 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S, 10355 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 10356 SourceLocation TypeLoc, 10357 ParsedType ParsedArgTy, 10358 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr, 10359 unsigned NumComponents, 10360 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 10361 10362 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo; 10363 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo); 10364 if (ArgTy.isNull()) 10365 return ExprError(); 10366 10367 if (!ArgTInfo) 10368 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc); 10369 10370 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents, 10371 RParenLoc); 10372 } 10373 10374 10375 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 10376 Expr *CondExpr, 10377 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 10378 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 10379 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)"); 10380 10381 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 10382 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 10383 QualType resType; 10384 bool ValueDependent = false; 10385 bool CondIsTrue = false; 10386 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) { 10387 resType = Context.DependentTy; 10388 ValueDependent = true; 10389 } else { 10390 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression. 10391 llvm::APSInt condEval(32); 10392 ExprResult CondICE 10393 = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval, 10394 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false); 10395 if (CondICE.isInvalid()) 10396 return ExprError(); 10397 CondExpr = CondICE.get(); 10398 CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue(); 10399 10400 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr. 10401 Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr; 10402 10403 resType = ActiveExpr->getType(); 10404 ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent(); 10405 VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind(); 10406 OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind(); 10407 } 10408 10409 return new (Context) 10410 ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc, 10411 CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent); 10412 } 10413 10414 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 10415 // Clang Extensions. 10416 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 10417 10418 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started. 10419 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 10420 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc); 10421 10422 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) { 10423 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 10424 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx = 10425 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext(), 10426 ManglingContextDecl)) { 10427 unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block); 10428 Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl); 10429 } 10430 } 10431 10432 PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block); 10433 CurContext->addDecl(Block); 10434 if (CurScope) 10435 PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block); 10436 else 10437 CurContext = Block; 10438 10439 getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true; 10440 10441 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any 10442 // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression. 10443 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(PotentiallyEvaluated); 10444 } 10445 10446 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo, 10447 Scope *CurScope) { 10448 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr && 10449 "block-id should have no identifier!"); 10450 assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == Declarator::BlockLiteralContext); 10451 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock(); 10452 10453 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope); 10454 QualType T = Sig->getType(); 10455 10456 // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would, 10457 // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs. 10458 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) { 10459 // Drop the parameters. 10460 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 10461 EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false; 10462 EPI.TypeQuals |= DeclSpec::TQ_const; 10463 T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI); 10464 Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 10465 } 10466 10467 // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block 10468 // literal signature. Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType 10469 // unless the function was written with a typedef. 10470 assert(T->isFunctionType() && 10471 "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature"); 10472 10473 // Look for an explicit signature in that function type. 10474 FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature; 10475 10476 TypeLoc tmp = Sig->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens(); 10477 if ((ExplicitSignature = tmp.getAs<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) { 10478 10479 // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by 10480 // GetTypeForDeclarator. If so, don't save that as part of the 10481 // written signature. 10482 if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() == 10483 ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) { 10484 // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of 10485 // TypeSourceInfos. 10486 TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc(); 10487 unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize(); 10488 Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size); 10489 Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size); 10490 10491 ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc(); 10492 } 10493 } 10494 10495 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig); 10496 CurBlock->FunctionType = T; 10497 10498 const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>(); 10499 QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType(); 10500 bool isVariadic = 10501 (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic()); 10502 10503 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic); 10504 10505 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block 10506 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like: 10507 // ^ * { ... } 10508 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction".... 10509 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) { 10510 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy; 10511 CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false); 10512 CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false; 10513 } 10514 10515 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them. 10516 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params; 10517 if (ExplicitSignature) { 10518 for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) { 10519 ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I); 10520 if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr && 10521 !Param->isImplicit() && 10522 !Param->isInvalidDecl() && 10523 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 10524 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted); 10525 Params.push_back(Param); 10526 } 10527 10528 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like 10529 // ^ fntype { ... } 10530 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 10531 for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) { 10532 ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef( 10533 CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getLocStart(), I); 10534 Params.push_back(Param); 10535 } 10536 } 10537 10538 // Set the parameters on the block decl. 10539 if (!Params.empty()) { 10540 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params); 10541 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(), 10542 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(), 10543 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false); 10544 } 10545 10546 // Finally we can process decl attributes. 10547 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo); 10548 10549 // Put the parameter variables in scope. 10550 for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->params()) { 10551 AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl); 10552 10553 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 10554 if (AI->getIdentifier()) { 10555 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI); 10556 10557 PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope); 10558 } 10559 } 10560 } 10561 10562 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback 10563 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl. 10564 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 10565 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 10566 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10567 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10568 10569 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks. 10570 PopDeclContext(); 10571 PopFunctionScopeInfo(); 10572 } 10573 10574 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement 10575 /// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...} 10576 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc, 10577 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) { 10578 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error. 10579 if (!LangOpts.Blocks) 10580 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable); 10581 10582 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 10583 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 10584 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 10585 assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within block not correctly bound!"); 10586 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 10587 10588 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back()); 10589 10590 if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType) 10591 deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI); 10592 10593 PopDeclContext(); 10594 10595 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy; 10596 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull()) 10597 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType; 10598 10599 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>(); 10600 QualType BlockTy; 10601 10602 // Set the captured variables on the block. 10603 // FIXME: Share capture structure between BlockDecl and CapturingScopeInfo! 10604 SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures; 10605 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Captures.size(); i != e; i++) { 10606 CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = BSI->Captures[i]; 10607 if (Cap.isThisCapture()) 10608 continue; 10609 BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Cap.getVariable(), Cap.isBlockCapture(), 10610 Cap.isNested(), Cap.getInitExpr()); 10611 Captures.push_back(NewCap); 10612 } 10613 BSI->TheDecl->setCaptures(Context, Captures.begin(), Captures.end(), 10614 BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0); 10615 10616 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that. 10617 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) { 10618 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 10619 10620 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo(); 10621 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true); 10622 10623 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types. 10624 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) { 10625 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 10626 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 10627 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 10628 10629 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type, 10630 // preserve its sugar structure. 10631 } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy && 10632 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) { 10633 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType; 10634 10635 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type. 10636 } else { 10637 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy); 10638 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 10639 EPI.TypeQuals = 0; // FIXME: silently? 10640 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 10641 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 10642 } 10643 10644 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing. 10645 } else { 10646 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 10647 EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn); 10648 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 10649 } 10650 10651 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(), 10652 BSI->TheDecl->param_end()); 10653 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy); 10654 10655 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block. 10656 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && 10657 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 10658 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 10659 10660 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 10661 10662 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again 10663 // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around 10664 // to deduce an implicit return type. 10665 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() && 10666 !BSI->TheDecl->isDependentContext()) 10667 computeNRVO(Body, BSI); 10668 10669 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy); 10670 AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 10671 PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, Result->getBlockDecl(), Result); 10672 10673 // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at 10674 // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context: 10675 if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) { 10676 // First, this expression has a new cleanup object. 10677 ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl()); 10678 ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 10679 10680 // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured 10681 // variables needs destruction. 10682 for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) { 10683 const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable(); 10684 if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) { 10685 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope(); 10686 break; 10687 } 10688 } 10689 } 10690 10691 return Result; 10692 } 10693 10694 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 10695 Expr *E, ParsedType Ty, 10696 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 10697 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 10698 GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 10699 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc); 10700 } 10701 10702 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 10703 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 10704 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 10705 Expr *OrigExpr = E; 10706 10707 // Get the va_list type 10708 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 10709 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) { 10710 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64, 10711 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to 10712 // a pointer for va_arg. 10713 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType); 10714 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately. 10715 ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 10716 if (Result.isInvalid()) 10717 return ExprError(); 10718 E = Result.get(); 10719 } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10720 // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode, 10721 // check the argument using reference binding. 10722 InitializedEntity Entity 10723 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, 10724 Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false); 10725 ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E); 10726 if (Init.isInvalid()) 10727 return ExprError(); 10728 E = Init.getAs<Expr>(); 10729 } else { 10730 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because 10731 // it is modified by va_arg. 10732 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && 10733 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this)) 10734 return ExprError(); 10735 } 10736 10737 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && 10738 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) { 10739 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(), 10740 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list) 10741 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange()); 10742 } 10743 10744 if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) { 10745 if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(), 10746 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete, 10747 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 10748 return ExprError(); 10749 10750 if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 10751 TInfo->getType(), 10752 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract, 10753 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 10754 return ExprError(); 10755 10756 if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) { 10757 Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 10758 TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType() 10759 ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified 10760 : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod) 10761 << TInfo->getType() 10762 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 10763 } 10764 10765 // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted 10766 // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior). 10767 QualType PromoteType; 10768 if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 10769 PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType()); 10770 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType())) 10771 PromoteType = QualType(); 10772 } 10773 if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) 10774 PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy; 10775 if (!PromoteType.isNull()) 10776 DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E, 10777 PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible) 10778 << TInfo->getType() 10779 << PromoteType 10780 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()); 10781 } 10782 10783 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context); 10784 return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T); 10785 } 10786 10787 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) { 10788 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of 10789 // pointers on the target. 10790 QualType Ty; 10791 unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0); 10792 if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth()) 10793 Ty = Context.IntTy; 10794 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth()) 10795 Ty = Context.LongTy; 10796 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth()) 10797 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 10798 else { 10799 llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!"); 10800 } 10801 10802 return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc); 10803 } 10804 10805 bool 10806 Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp) { 10807 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1) 10808 return false; 10809 10810 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 10811 if (!PT) 10812 return false; 10813 10814 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) { 10815 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface. 10816 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl(); 10817 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString")) 10818 return false; 10819 } 10820 10821 // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be 10822 // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values. The last is 10823 // important for making this trigger for property assignments. 10824 Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10825 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr)) 10826 if (OV->getSourceExpr()) 10827 SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10828 10829 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr); 10830 if (!SL || !SL->isAscii()) 10831 return false; 10832 Diag(SL->getLocStart(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix) 10833 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@"); 10834 Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getLocStart(), SL).get(); 10835 return true; 10836 } 10837 10838 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy, 10839 SourceLocation Loc, 10840 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, 10841 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action, 10842 bool *Complained) { 10843 if (Complained) 10844 *Complained = false; 10845 10846 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions). 10847 bool CheckInferredResultType = false; 10848 bool isInvalid = false; 10849 unsigned DiagKind = 0; 10850 FixItHint Hint; 10851 ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints; 10852 bool MayHaveConvFixit = false; 10853 bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false; 10854 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 10855 const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr; 10856 10857 switch (ConvTy) { 10858 case Compatible: 10859 DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr); 10860 return false; 10861 10862 case PointerToInt: 10863 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int; 10864 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 10865 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 10866 break; 10867 case IntToPointer: 10868 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer; 10869 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 10870 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 10871 break; 10872 case IncompatiblePointer: 10873 DiagKind = 10874 (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited ? 10875 diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer : 10876 diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer); 10877 CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 10878 SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType(); 10879 if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) { 10880 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 10881 } 10882 else if (CheckInferredResultType) { 10883 SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType(); 10884 DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType(); 10885 } 10886 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 10887 break; 10888 case IncompatiblePointerSign: 10889 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign; 10890 break; 10891 case FunctionVoidPointer: 10892 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func; 10893 break; 10894 case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: { 10895 // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary. 10896 if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType); 10897 10898 Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 10899 Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 10900 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) { 10901 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space; 10902 break; 10903 10904 10905 } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) { 10906 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership; 10907 break; 10908 } 10909 10910 llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!"); 10911 // fallthrough 10912 } 10913 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 10914 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the 10915 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char* 10916 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME: 10917 // Ideally, this check would be performed in 10918 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a 10919 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an 10920 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part 10921 // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for 10922 // C++ semantics. 10923 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 10924 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType)) 10925 return false; 10926 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers; 10927 break; 10928 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers: 10929 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch; 10930 break; 10931 case IntToBlockPointer: 10932 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer; 10933 break; 10934 case IncompatibleBlockPointer: 10935 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer; 10936 break; 10937 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: { 10938 if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 10939 const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT = 10940 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 10941 for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) { 10942 PDecl = srcProto; 10943 break; 10944 } 10945 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 10946 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 10947 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 10948 } 10949 else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 10950 const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT = 10951 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 10952 for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) { 10953 PDecl = dstProto; 10954 break; 10955 } 10956 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 10957 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 10958 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 10959 } 10960 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id; 10961 break; 10962 } 10963 case IncompatibleVectors: 10964 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors; 10965 break; 10966 case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef: 10967 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign; 10968 break; 10969 case Incompatible: 10970 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible; 10971 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 10972 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 10973 isInvalid = true; 10974 MayHaveFunctionDiff = true; 10975 break; 10976 } 10977 10978 QualType FirstType, SecondType; 10979 switch (Action) { 10980 case AA_Assigning: 10981 case AA_Initializing: 10982 // The destination type comes first. 10983 FirstType = DstType; 10984 SecondType = SrcType; 10985 break; 10986 10987 case AA_Returning: 10988 case AA_Passing: 10989 case AA_Passing_CFAudited: 10990 case AA_Converting: 10991 case AA_Sending: 10992 case AA_Casting: 10993 // The source type comes first. 10994 FirstType = SrcType; 10995 SecondType = DstType; 10996 break; 10997 } 10998 10999 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind); 11000 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited) 11001 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 11002 else 11003 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 11004 11005 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 11006 assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull()); 11007 if (!ConvHints.isNull()) { 11008 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = ConvHints.Hints.begin(), 11009 HE = ConvHints.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI) 11010 FDiag << *HI; 11011 } else { 11012 FDiag << Hint; 11013 } 11014 if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); } 11015 11016 if (MayHaveFunctionDiff) 11017 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType); 11018 11019 Diag(Loc, FDiag); 11020 if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id && 11021 PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition()) 11022 Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::not_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id) 11023 << IFace->getName() << PDecl->getName(); 11024 11025 if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy) 11026 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression, 11027 FirstType); 11028 11029 if (CheckInferredResultType) 11030 EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr); 11031 11032 if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer) 11033 EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType); 11034 11035 if (Complained) 11036 *Complained = true; 11037 return isInvalid; 11038 } 11039 11040 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 11041 llvm::APSInt *Result) { 11042 class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 11043 public: 11044 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 11045 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR; 11046 } 11047 } Diagnoser; 11048 11049 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser); 11050 } 11051 11052 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 11053 llvm::APSInt *Result, 11054 unsigned DiagID, 11055 bool AllowFold) { 11056 class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 11057 unsigned DiagID; 11058 11059 public: 11060 IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID) 11061 : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { } 11062 11063 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 11064 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR; 11065 } 11066 } Diagnoser(DiagID); 11067 11068 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold); 11069 } 11070 11071 void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 11072 SourceRange SR) { 11073 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus; 11074 } 11075 11076 ExprResult 11077 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result, 11078 VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser, 11079 bool AllowFold) { 11080 SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getLocStart(); 11081 11082 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 11083 // C++11 [expr.const]p5: 11084 // If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an 11085 // integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall 11086 // have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or 11087 // unscoped enumeration type 11088 ExprResult Converted; 11089 class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser { 11090 public: 11091 CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent) 11092 : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false, 11093 Silent, true) {} 11094 11095 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 11096 QualType T) override { 11097 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T; 11098 } 11099 11100 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete( 11101 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 11102 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T; 11103 } 11104 11105 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv( 11106 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 11107 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy; 11108 } 11109 11110 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv( 11111 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 11112 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 11113 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 11114 } 11115 11116 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous( 11117 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 11118 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T; 11119 } 11120 11121 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous( 11122 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 11123 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 11124 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 11125 } 11126 11127 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion( 11128 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 11129 llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted"); 11130 } 11131 } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress); 11132 11133 Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E, 11134 ConvertDiagnoser); 11135 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 11136 return Converted; 11137 E = Converted.get(); 11138 if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 11139 return ExprError(); 11140 } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 11141 // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type. 11142 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) 11143 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 11144 return ExprError(); 11145 } 11146 11147 // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice 11148 // in the non-ICE case. 11149 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) { 11150 if (Result) 11151 *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstInt(Context); 11152 return E; 11153 } 11154 11155 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult; 11156 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 11157 EvalResult.Diag = &Notes; 11158 11159 // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's 11160 // not a constant expression as a side-effect. 11161 bool Folded = E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context) && 11162 EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects; 11163 11164 // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression 11165 // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then 11166 // this is a constant expression. 11167 if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) { 11168 if (Result) 11169 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 11170 return E; 11171 } 11172 11173 // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point 11174 // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially 11175 // redundant note. 11176 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 11177 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 11178 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 11179 Notes.clear(); 11180 } 11181 11182 if (!Folded || !AllowFold) { 11183 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) { 11184 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 11185 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 11186 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 11187 } 11188 11189 return ExprError(); 11190 } 11191 11192 Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 11193 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I) 11194 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second); 11195 11196 if (Result) 11197 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 11198 return E; 11199 } 11200 11201 namespace { 11202 // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively 11203 // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated. 11204 class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> { 11205 typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform; 11206 11207 public: 11208 TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { } 11209 11210 // Make sure we redo semantic analysis 11211 bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; } 11212 11213 // Make sure we handle LabelStmts correctly. 11214 // FIXME: This does the right thing, but maybe we need a more general 11215 // fix to TreeTransform? 11216 StmtResult TransformLabelStmt(LabelStmt *S) { 11217 S->getDecl()->setStmt(nullptr); 11218 return BaseTransform::TransformLabelStmt(S); 11219 } 11220 11221 // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which 11222 // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming 11223 // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST. 11224 // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this 11225 // case? 11226 // 11227 // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls. 11228 ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 11229 if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) && 11230 !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) 11231 return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(), 11232 diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use) 11233 << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange(); 11234 11235 return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E); 11236 } 11237 11238 // Exception: filter out member pointer formation 11239 ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 11240 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType()) 11241 return E; 11242 11243 return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E); 11244 } 11245 11246 ExprResult TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) { 11247 // Lambdas never need to be transformed. 11248 return E; 11249 } 11250 }; 11251 } 11252 11253 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) { 11254 assert(isUnevaluatedContext() && 11255 "Should only transform unevaluated expressions"); 11256 ExprEvalContexts.back().Context = 11257 ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context; 11258 if (isUnevaluatedContext()) 11259 return E; 11260 return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E); 11261 } 11262 11263 void 11264 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, 11265 Decl *LambdaContextDecl, 11266 bool IsDecltype) { 11267 ExprEvalContexts.push_back( 11268 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, 11269 ExprCleanupObjects.size(), 11270 ExprNeedsCleanups, 11271 LambdaContextDecl, 11272 IsDecltype)); 11273 ExprNeedsCleanups = false; 11274 if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty()) 11275 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 11276 } 11277 11278 void 11279 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, 11280 ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t, 11281 bool IsDecltype) { 11282 Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl; 11283 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, IsDecltype); 11284 } 11285 11286 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() { 11287 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 11288 11289 if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) { 11290 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) { 11291 unsigned D; 11292 if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) { 11293 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2: 11294 // A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand 11295 // (Clause 5). 11296 D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand; 11297 } else { 11298 // C++1y [expr.const]p2: 11299 // A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the 11300 // evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would 11301 // evaluate [...] a lambda-expression. 11302 D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression; 11303 } 11304 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Rec.Lambdas.size(); I != N; ++I) 11305 Diag(Rec.Lambdas[I]->getLocStart(), D); 11306 } else { 11307 // Mark the capture expressions odr-used. This was deferred 11308 // during lambda expression creation. 11309 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Rec.Lambdas.size(); I != N; ++I) { 11310 LambdaExpr *Lambda = Rec.Lambdas[I]; 11311 for (LambdaExpr::capture_init_iterator 11312 C = Lambda->capture_init_begin(), 11313 CEnd = Lambda->capture_init_end(); 11314 C != CEnd; ++C) { 11315 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(*C); 11316 } 11317 } 11318 } 11319 } 11320 11321 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any 11322 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of 11323 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they 11324 // will never be constructed. 11325 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) { 11326 ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects, 11327 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 11328 ExprNeedsCleanups = Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups; 11329 CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 11330 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 11331 // Otherwise, merge the contexts together. 11332 } else { 11333 ExprNeedsCleanups |= Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups; 11334 MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(), 11335 Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end()); 11336 } 11337 11338 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack. 11339 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back(); 11340 } 11341 11342 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() { 11343 ExprCleanupObjects.erase( 11344 ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects, 11345 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 11346 ExprNeedsCleanups = false; 11347 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 11348 } 11349 11350 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) { 11351 if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 11352 return E; 11353 return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 11354 } 11355 11356 static bool IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) { 11357 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for 11358 // an instantiation. 11359 if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext()) 11360 return false; 11361 11362 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 11363 case Sema::Unevaluated: 11364 case Sema::UnevaluatedAbstract: 11365 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing. 11366 // (Depending on how you read the standard, we actually do need to do 11367 // something here for null pointer constants, but the standard's 11368 // definition of a null pointer constant is completely crazy.) 11369 return false; 11370 11371 case Sema::ConstantEvaluated: 11372 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated: 11373 // We are in a potentially evaluated expression (or a constant-expression 11374 // in C++03); we need to do implicit template instantiation, implicitly 11375 // define class members, and mark most declarations as used. 11376 return true; 11377 11378 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 11379 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the 11380 // containing expression is used. 11381 return false; 11382 } 11383 llvm_unreachable("Invalid context"); 11384 } 11385 11386 /// \brief Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 11387 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3) 11388 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func) { 11389 assert(Func && "No function?"); 11390 11391 Func->setReferenced(); 11392 11393 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3: 11394 // A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is 11395 // odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a 11396 // set of overloaded functions [...]. 11397 // 11398 // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we 11399 // can just check that here. Skip the rest of this function if we've already 11400 // marked the function as used. 11401 if (Func->isUsed(false) || !IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(*this)) { 11402 // C++11 [temp.inst]p3: 11403 // Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly 11404 // instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template 11405 // specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is 11406 // referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist. 11407 // 11408 // We consider constexpr function templates to be referenced in a context 11409 // that requires a definition to exist whenever they are referenced. 11410 // 11411 // FIXME: This instantiates constexpr functions too frequently. If this is 11412 // really an unevaluated context (and we're not just in the definition of a 11413 // function template or overload resolution or other cases which we 11414 // incorrectly consider to be unevaluated contexts), and we're not in a 11415 // subexpression which we actually need to evaluate (for instance, a 11416 // template argument, array bound or an expression in a braced-init-list), 11417 // we are not permitted to instantiate this constexpr function definition. 11418 // 11419 // FIXME: This also implicitly defines special members too frequently. They 11420 // are only supposed to be implicitly defined if they are odr-used, but they 11421 // are not odr-used from constant expressions in unevaluated contexts. 11422 // However, they cannot be referenced if they are deleted, and they are 11423 // deleted whenever the implicit definition of the special member would 11424 // fail. 11425 if (!Func->isConstexpr() || Func->getBody()) 11426 return; 11427 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func); 11428 if (!Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() && (!MD || MD->isUserProvided())) 11429 return; 11430 } 11431 11432 // Note that this declaration has been used. 11433 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 11434 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl()); 11435 if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) { 11436 if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) { 11437 if (Constructor->isTrivial() && !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 11438 return; 11439 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 11440 } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) { 11441 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 11442 } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) { 11443 DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 11444 } 11445 } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) { 11446 DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 11447 } 11448 11449 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent()); 11450 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 11451 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) { 11452 Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl()); 11453 if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) 11454 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor); 11455 if (Destructor->isVirtual()) 11456 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent()); 11457 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) { 11458 if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() && 11459 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) { 11460 MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 11461 if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) { 11462 if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 11463 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 11464 else 11465 DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 11466 } 11467 } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) && 11468 MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) { 11469 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 11470 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 11471 if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion()) 11472 DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 11473 else 11474 DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 11475 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual()) 11476 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent()); 11477 } 11478 11479 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function. 11480 // FIXME: Is this really right? 11481 if (CurContext == Func) return; 11482 11483 // Resolve the exception specification for any function which is 11484 // used: CodeGen will need it. 11485 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 11486 if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) 11487 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 11488 11489 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of 11490 // class templates. 11491 if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) { 11492 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false; 11493 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 11494 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo 11495 = Func->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) { 11496 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) 11497 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc); 11498 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind() 11499 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) { 11500 AlreadyInstantiated = true; 11501 PointOfInstantiation = SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation(); 11502 } 11503 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo 11504 = Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) { 11505 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) 11506 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc); 11507 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind() 11508 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) { 11509 AlreadyInstantiated = true; 11510 PointOfInstantiation = MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation(); 11511 } 11512 } 11513 11514 if (!AlreadyInstantiated || Func->isConstexpr()) { 11515 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) && 11516 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() && 11517 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.size()) 11518 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back( 11519 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation)); 11520 else if (Func->isConstexpr()) 11521 // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the 11522 // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a 11523 // call to such a function. 11524 InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func); 11525 else { 11526 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Func, 11527 PointOfInstantiation)); 11528 // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated. 11529 Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func); 11530 } 11531 } 11532 } else { 11533 // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable. 11534 for (auto i : Func->redecls()) { 11535 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) 11536 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i); 11537 } 11538 } 11539 11540 // Keep track of used but undefined functions. 11541 if (!Func->isDefined()) { 11542 if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func)) 11543 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 11544 else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() && 11545 (LangOpts.CPlusPlus || !LangOpts.GNUInline) && 11546 !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 11547 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 11548 } 11549 11550 // Normally the most current decl is marked used while processing the use and 11551 // any subsequent decls are marked used by decl merging. This fails with 11552 // template instantiation since marking can happen at the end of the file 11553 // and, because of the two phase lookup, this function is called with at 11554 // decl in the middle of a decl chain. We loop to maintain the invariant 11555 // that once a decl is used, all decls after it are also used. 11556 for (FunctionDecl *F = Func->getMostRecentDecl();; F = F->getPreviousDecl()) { 11557 F->markUsed(Context); 11558 if (F == Func) 11559 break; 11560 } 11561 } 11562 11563 static void 11564 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, 11565 VarDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) { 11566 DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext(); 11567 11568 // If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then 11569 // we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of 11570 // the next. 11571 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) && 11572 isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC)) 11573 return; 11574 11575 // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code 11576 // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of 11577 // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later. 11578 // 11579 // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this 11580 // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound 11581 // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious. 11582 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 11583 return; 11584 11585 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) && 11586 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) { 11587 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_lambda) 11588 << var->getIdentifier(); 11589 } else if (FunctionDecl *fn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) { 11590 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function) 11591 << var->getIdentifier() << fn->getDeclName(); 11592 } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) { 11593 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_block) 11594 << var->getIdentifier(); 11595 } else { 11596 // FIXME: Is there any other context where a local variable can be 11597 // declared? 11598 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_context) 11599 << var->getIdentifier(); 11600 } 11601 11602 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 11603 << var->getIdentifier(); 11604 11605 // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents 11606 // capture. 11607 } 11608 11609 11610 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 11611 bool &SubCapturesAreNested, 11612 QualType &CaptureType, 11613 QualType &DeclRefType) { 11614 // Check whether we've already captured it. 11615 if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) { 11616 // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested. 11617 SubCapturesAreNested = true; 11618 11619 // Retrieve the capture type for this variable. 11620 CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType(); 11621 11622 // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable. 11623 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 11624 11625 const CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var); 11626 if (Cap.isCopyCapture() && 11627 !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable)) 11628 DeclRefType.addConst(); 11629 return true; 11630 } 11631 return false; 11632 } 11633 11634 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 11635 // capture; other scopes don't work. 11636 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var, 11637 SourceLocation Loc, 11638 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 11639 if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC)) 11640 return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 11641 else { 11642 if (Diagnose) 11643 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC); 11644 } 11645 return nullptr; 11646 } 11647 11648 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 11649 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 11650 // so check for eligibility. 11651 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 11652 SourceLocation Loc, 11653 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 11654 11655 bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI); 11656 bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 11657 11658 // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables 11659 // (e.g. anonymous unions). 11660 // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm 11661 // assuming that's the intent. 11662 if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) { 11663 if (Diagnose) { 11664 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var); 11665 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 11666 } 11667 return false; 11668 } 11669 11670 // Prohibit variably-modified types; they're difficult to deal with. 11671 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && (IsBlock || IsLambda)) { 11672 if (Diagnose) { 11673 if (IsBlock) 11674 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type); 11675 else 11676 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_vm_type) << Var->getDeclName(); 11677 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 11678 << Var->getDeclName(); 11679 } 11680 return false; 11681 } 11682 // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too. 11683 // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct. 11684 if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 11685 if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 11686 if (Diagnose) { 11687 if (IsBlock) 11688 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type); 11689 else 11690 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type) 11691 << Var->getDeclName(); 11692 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 11693 << Var->getDeclName(); 11694 } 11695 return false; 11696 } 11697 } 11698 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 11699 // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block 11700 // variables; they don't support the expected semantics. 11701 if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) { 11702 if (Diagnose) { 11703 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable) 11704 << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda; 11705 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 11706 << Var->getDeclName(); 11707 } 11708 return false; 11709 } 11710 11711 return true; 11712 } 11713 11714 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful. 11715 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var, 11716 SourceLocation Loc, 11717 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 11718 QualType &CaptureType, 11719 QualType &DeclRefType, 11720 const bool Nested, 11721 Sema &S) { 11722 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 11723 bool ByRef = false; 11724 11725 // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays. 11726 if (CaptureType->isArrayType()) { 11727 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 11728 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type); 11729 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 11730 << Var->getDeclName(); 11731 } 11732 return false; 11733 } 11734 11735 // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables. 11736 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 11737 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 11738 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) 11739 << /*block*/ 0; 11740 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 11741 << Var->getDeclName(); 11742 } 11743 return false; 11744 } 11745 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 11746 if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType()) { 11747 // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or 11748 // declaration reference types. 11749 ByRef = true; 11750 } else { 11751 // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'. 11752 CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst(); 11753 DeclRefType = CaptureType; 11754 11755 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuildAndDiagnose) { 11756 if (const RecordType *Record = DeclRefType->getAs<RecordType>()) { 11757 // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it. 11758 // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have 11759 // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are 11760 // an exception because it's technically only the call site that 11761 // actually requires the destructor. 11762 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 11763 S.FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record); 11764 11765 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the copy 11766 // full-expression. 11767 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(S, S.PotentiallyEvaluated); 11768 11769 // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from 11770 // the stack requires a const copy constructor. This is not true 11771 // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap. 11772 Expr *DeclRef = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, Nested, 11773 DeclRefType.withConst(), 11774 VK_LValue, Loc); 11775 11776 ExprResult Result 11777 = S.PerformCopyInitialization( 11778 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(), 11779 CaptureType, false), 11780 Loc, DeclRef); 11781 11782 // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization 11783 // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor. Recover from 11784 // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary. 11785 if (!Result.isInvalid() && 11786 !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor() 11787 ->isTrivial()) { 11788 Result = S.MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result); 11789 CopyExpr = Result.get(); 11790 } 11791 } 11792 } 11793 } 11794 11795 // Actually capture the variable. 11796 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 11797 BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc, 11798 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr); 11799 11800 return true; 11801 11802 } 11803 11804 11805 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the captured region. 11806 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI, 11807 VarDecl *Var, 11808 SourceLocation Loc, 11809 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 11810 QualType &CaptureType, 11811 QualType &DeclRefType, 11812 const bool RefersToEnclosingLocal, 11813 Sema &S) { 11814 11815 // By default, capture variables by reference. 11816 bool ByRef = true; 11817 // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below). 11818 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 11819 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 11820 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 11821 // The current implementation assumes that all variables are captured 11822 // by references. Since there is no capture by copy, no expression 11823 // evaluation will be needed. 11824 RecordDecl *RD = RSI->TheRecordDecl; 11825 11826 FieldDecl *Field 11827 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, RD, Loc, Loc, nullptr, CaptureType, 11828 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CaptureType, Loc), 11829 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit); 11830 Field->setImplicit(true); 11831 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 11832 RD->addDecl(Field); 11833 11834 CopyExpr = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToEnclosingLocal, 11835 DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc); 11836 Var->setReferenced(true); 11837 Var->markUsed(S.Context); 11838 } 11839 11840 // Actually capture the variable. 11841 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 11842 RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/false, ByRef, RefersToEnclosingLocal, Loc, 11843 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr); 11844 11845 11846 return true; 11847 } 11848 11849 /// \brief Create a field within the lambda class for the variable 11850 /// being captured. Handle Array captures. 11851 static ExprResult addAsFieldToClosureType(Sema &S, 11852 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 11853 VarDecl *Var, QualType FieldType, 11854 QualType DeclRefType, 11855 SourceLocation Loc, 11856 bool RefersToEnclosingLocal) { 11857 CXXRecordDecl *Lambda = LSI->Lambda; 11858 11859 // Build the non-static data member. 11860 FieldDecl *Field 11861 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, Lambda, Loc, Loc, nullptr, FieldType, 11862 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FieldType, Loc), 11863 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit); 11864 Field->setImplicit(true); 11865 Field->setAccess(AS_private); 11866 Lambda->addDecl(Field); 11867 11868 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p21: 11869 // When the lambda-expression is evaluated, the entities that 11870 // are captured by copy are used to direct-initialize each 11871 // corresponding non-static data member of the resulting closure 11872 // object. (For array members, the array elements are 11873 // direct-initialized in increasing subscript order.) These 11874 // initializations are performed in the (unspecified) order in 11875 // which the non-static data members are declared. 11876 11877 // Introduce a new evaluation context for the initialization, so 11878 // that temporaries introduced as part of the capture are retained 11879 // to be re-"exported" from the lambda expression itself. 11880 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(S, Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated); 11881 11882 // C++ [expr.prim.labda]p12: 11883 // An entity captured by a lambda-expression is odr-used (3.2) in 11884 // the scope containing the lambda-expression. 11885 Expr *Ref = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToEnclosingLocal, 11886 DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc); 11887 Var->setReferenced(true); 11888 Var->markUsed(S.Context); 11889 11890 // When the field has array type, create index variables for each 11891 // dimension of the array. We use these index variables to subscript 11892 // the source array, and other clients (e.g., CodeGen) will perform 11893 // the necessary iteration with these index variables. 11894 SmallVector<VarDecl *, 4> IndexVariables; 11895 QualType BaseType = FieldType; 11896 QualType SizeType = S.Context.getSizeType(); 11897 LSI->ArrayIndexStarts.push_back(LSI->ArrayIndexVars.size()); 11898 while (const ConstantArrayType *Array 11899 = S.Context.getAsConstantArrayType(BaseType)) { 11900 // Create the iteration variable for this array index. 11901 IdentifierInfo *IterationVarName = nullptr; 11902 { 11903 SmallString<8> Str; 11904 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); 11905 OS << "__i" << IndexVariables.size(); 11906 IterationVarName = &S.Context.Idents.get(OS.str()); 11907 } 11908 VarDecl *IterationVar 11909 = VarDecl::Create(S.Context, S.CurContext, Loc, Loc, 11910 IterationVarName, SizeType, 11911 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(SizeType, Loc), 11912 SC_None); 11913 IndexVariables.push_back(IterationVar); 11914 LSI->ArrayIndexVars.push_back(IterationVar); 11915 11916 // Create a reference to the iteration variable. 11917 ExprResult IterationVarRef 11918 = S.BuildDeclRefExpr(IterationVar, SizeType, VK_LValue, Loc); 11919 assert(!IterationVarRef.isInvalid() && 11920 "Reference to invented variable cannot fail!"); 11921 IterationVarRef = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(IterationVarRef.get()); 11922 assert(!IterationVarRef.isInvalid() && 11923 "Conversion of invented variable cannot fail!"); 11924 11925 // Subscript the array with this iteration variable. 11926 ExprResult Subscript = S.CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr( 11927 Ref, Loc, IterationVarRef.get(), Loc); 11928 if (Subscript.isInvalid()) { 11929 S.CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 11930 S.DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 11931 return ExprError(); 11932 } 11933 11934 Ref = Subscript.get(); 11935 BaseType = Array->getElementType(); 11936 } 11937 11938 // Construct the entity that we will be initializing. For an array, this 11939 // will be first element in the array, which may require several levels 11940 // of array-subscript entities. 11941 SmallVector<InitializedEntity, 4> Entities; 11942 Entities.reserve(1 + IndexVariables.size()); 11943 Entities.push_back( 11944 InitializedEntity::InitializeLambdaCapture(Var->getIdentifier(), 11945 Field->getType(), Loc)); 11946 for (unsigned I = 0, N = IndexVariables.size(); I != N; ++I) 11947 Entities.push_back(InitializedEntity::InitializeElement(S.Context, 11948 0, 11949 Entities.back())); 11950 11951 InitializationKind InitKind 11952 = InitializationKind::CreateDirect(Loc, Loc, Loc); 11953 InitializationSequence Init(S, Entities.back(), InitKind, Ref); 11954 ExprResult Result(true); 11955 if (!Init.Diagnose(S, Entities.back(), InitKind, Ref)) 11956 Result = Init.Perform(S, Entities.back(), InitKind, Ref); 11957 11958 // If this initialization requires any cleanups (e.g., due to a 11959 // default argument to a copy constructor), note that for the 11960 // lambda. 11961 if (S.ExprNeedsCleanups) 11962 LSI->ExprNeedsCleanups = true; 11963 11964 // Exit the expression evaluation context used for the capture. 11965 S.CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 11966 S.DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 11967 return Result; 11968 } 11969 11970 11971 11972 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the lambda. 11973 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 11974 VarDecl *Var, 11975 SourceLocation Loc, 11976 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 11977 QualType &CaptureType, 11978 QualType &DeclRefType, 11979 const bool RefersToEnclosingLocal, 11980 const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind, 11981 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, 11982 const bool IsTopScope, 11983 Sema &S) { 11984 11985 // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value. 11986 bool ByRef = false; 11987 if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) { 11988 ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef); 11989 } else { 11990 ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref); 11991 } 11992 11993 // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable. 11994 if (ByRef) { 11995 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15: 11996 // An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or 11997 // explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is 11998 // unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data 11999 // members are declared in the closure type for entities 12000 // captured by reference. 12001 // 12002 // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference 12003 // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears 12004 // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will 12005 // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and 12006 // easily defensible position. 12007 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 12008 } else { 12009 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14: 12010 // For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static 12011 // data member is declared in the closure type. The 12012 // declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type 12013 // of such a data member is the type of the corresponding 12014 // captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an 12015 // object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the 12016 // captured entity is a reference to a function, the 12017 // corresponding data member is also a reference to a 12018 // function. - end note ] 12019 if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){ 12020 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 12021 CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType(); 12022 } 12023 12024 // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables. 12025 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 12026 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12027 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1; 12028 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12029 << Var->getDeclName(); 12030 } 12031 return false; 12032 } 12033 12034 // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type. 12035 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12036 if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() && 12037 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType, 12038 diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type, 12039 Var->getDeclName())) 12040 return false; 12041 12042 if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType, 12043 diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type)) 12044 return false; 12045 } 12046 } 12047 12048 // Capture this variable in the lambda. 12049 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 12050 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12051 ExprResult Result = addAsFieldToClosureType(S, LSI, Var, 12052 CaptureType, DeclRefType, Loc, 12053 RefersToEnclosingLocal); 12054 if (!Result.isInvalid()) 12055 CopyExpr = Result.get(); 12056 } 12057 12058 // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable. 12059 if (ByRef) 12060 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12061 else { 12062 // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5: 12063 // The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline 12064 // function call operator [...]. This function call operator is 12065 // declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expressions 12066 // parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable. 12067 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12068 if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType()) 12069 DeclRefType.addConst(); 12070 } 12071 12072 // Add the capture. 12073 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 12074 LSI->addCapture(Var, /*IsBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToEnclosingLocal, 12075 Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, CopyExpr); 12076 12077 return true; 12078 } 12079 12080 12081 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, 12082 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, 12083 bool BuildAndDiagnose, 12084 QualType &CaptureType, 12085 QualType &DeclRefType, 12086 const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 12087 bool Nested = false; 12088 12089 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 12090 const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 12091 ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 12092 // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the 12093 // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 12094 if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 12095 unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 12096 while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) { 12097 DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 12098 --FSIndex; 12099 } 12100 } 12101 12102 12103 // If the variable is declared in the current context (and is not an 12104 // init-capture), there is no need to capture it. 12105 if (!Var->isInitCapture() && Var->getDeclContext() == DC) return true; 12106 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage()) return true; 12107 12108 // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable, 12109 // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when 12110 // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing 12111 // capture of that variable. We start from the innermost capturing-entity 12112 // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities 12113 // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s 12114 // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured 12115 // the variable. 12116 CaptureType = Var->getType(); 12117 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 12118 bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit); 12119 unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex; 12120 do { 12121 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 12122 // capture; other scopes don't work. 12123 DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var, 12124 ExprLoc, 12125 BuildAndDiagnose, 12126 *this); 12127 if (!ParentDC) return true; 12128 12129 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex]; 12130 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI); 12131 12132 12133 // Check whether we've already captured it. 12134 if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType, 12135 DeclRefType)) 12136 break; 12137 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body, 12138 // we do not want to capture new variables. What was captured 12139 // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing 12140 // should be used. 12141 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) { 12142 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12143 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 12144 if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) { 12145 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 12146 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12147 << Var->getDeclName(); 12148 Diag(LSI->Lambda->getLocStart(), diag::note_lambda_decl); 12149 } else 12150 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC); 12151 } 12152 return true; 12153 } 12154 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 12155 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 12156 // so check for eligibility. 12157 if (!isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this)) 12158 return true; 12159 12160 // Try to capture variable-length arrays types. 12161 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 12162 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA 12163 // expressions. 12164 QualType QTy = Var->getType(); 12165 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 12166 QTy = PVD->getOriginalType(); 12167 do { 12168 const Type *Ty = QTy.getTypePtr(); 12169 switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) { 12170 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 12171 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 12172 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) 12173 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 12174 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) 12175 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 12176 QTy = QualType(); 12177 break; 12178 // These types are never variably-modified. 12179 case Type::Builtin: 12180 case Type::Complex: 12181 case Type::Vector: 12182 case Type::ExtVector: 12183 case Type::Record: 12184 case Type::Enum: 12185 case Type::Elaborated: 12186 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: 12187 case Type::ObjCObject: 12188 case Type::ObjCInterface: 12189 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 12190 llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!"); 12191 case Type::Adjusted: 12192 QTy = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType(); 12193 break; 12194 case Type::Decayed: 12195 QTy = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12196 break; 12197 case Type::Pointer: 12198 QTy = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12199 break; 12200 case Type::BlockPointer: 12201 QTy = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12202 break; 12203 case Type::LValueReference: 12204 case Type::RValueReference: 12205 QTy = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12206 break; 12207 case Type::MemberPointer: 12208 QTy = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 12209 break; 12210 case Type::ConstantArray: 12211 case Type::IncompleteArray: 12212 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 12213 QTy = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType(); 12214 break; 12215 case Type::VariableArray: { 12216 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 12217 const VariableArrayType *Vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty); 12218 12219 // Unknown size indication requires no size computation. 12220 // Otherwise, evaluate and record it. 12221 if (Expr *Size = Vat->getSizeExpr()) { 12222 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Size); 12223 } 12224 QTy = Vat->getElementType(); 12225 break; 12226 } 12227 case Type::FunctionProto: 12228 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 12229 QTy = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType(); 12230 break; 12231 case Type::Paren: 12232 case Type::TypeOf: 12233 case Type::UnaryTransform: 12234 case Type::Attributed: 12235 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm: 12236 case Type::PackExpansion: 12237 // Keep walking after single level desugaring. 12238 QTy = QTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(getASTContext()); 12239 break; 12240 case Type::Typedef: 12241 QTy = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar(); 12242 break; 12243 case Type::Decltype: 12244 QTy = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar(); 12245 break; 12246 case Type::Auto: 12247 QTy = cast<AutoType>(Ty)->getDeducedType(); 12248 break; 12249 case Type::TypeOfExpr: 12250 QTy = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType(); 12251 break; 12252 case Type::Atomic: 12253 QTy = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType(); 12254 break; 12255 } 12256 } while (!QTy.isNull() && QTy->isVariablyModifiedType()); 12257 } 12258 12259 if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) { 12260 // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture 12261 // so cannot capture this variable. 12262 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 12263 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 12264 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 12265 << Var->getDeclName(); 12266 Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getLocStart(), 12267 diag::note_lambda_decl); 12268 // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly 12269 // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we 12270 // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because 12271 // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later. This would purely be done 12272 // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable 12273 // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured 12274 // explicitly. Suggestion: 12275 // - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit 12276 // at the function head 12277 // - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda 12278 // - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable. 12279 } 12280 return true; 12281 } 12282 12283 FunctionScopesIndex--; 12284 DC = ParentDC; 12285 Explicit = false; 12286 } while (!Var->getDeclContext()->Equals(DC)); 12287 12288 // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda) 12289 // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific 12290 // requirements, and adding captures if requested. 12291 // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing 12292 // at the lambda nested within that one. 12293 for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N; 12294 ++I) { 12295 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]); 12296 12297 if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12298 if (!captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc, 12299 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 12300 DeclRefType, Nested, *this)) 12301 return true; 12302 Nested = true; 12303 } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 12304 if (!captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc, 12305 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 12306 DeclRefType, Nested, *this)) 12307 return true; 12308 Nested = true; 12309 } else { 12310 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 12311 if (!captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc, 12312 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 12313 DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 12314 /*IsTopScope*/I == N - 1, *this)) 12315 return true; 12316 Nested = true; 12317 } 12318 } 12319 return false; 12320 } 12321 12322 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, 12323 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) { 12324 QualType CaptureType; 12325 QualType DeclRefType; 12326 return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 12327 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType, 12328 DeclRefType, nullptr); 12329 } 12330 12331 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 12332 QualType CaptureType; 12333 QualType DeclRefType; 12334 12335 // Determine whether we can capture this variable. 12336 if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 12337 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 12338 DeclRefType, nullptr)) 12339 return QualType(); 12340 12341 return DeclRefType; 12342 } 12343 12344 12345 12346 // If either the type of the variable or the initializer is dependent, 12347 // return false. Otherwise, determine whether the variable is a constant 12348 // expression. Use this if you need to know if a variable that might or 12349 // might not be dependent is truly a constant expression. 12350 static inline bool IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(VarDecl *Var, 12351 ASTContext &Context) { 12352 12353 if (Var->getType()->isDependentType()) 12354 return false; 12355 const VarDecl *DefVD = nullptr; 12356 Var->getAnyInitializer(DefVD); 12357 if (!DefVD) 12358 return false; 12359 EvaluatedStmt *Eval = DefVD->ensureEvaluatedStmt(); 12360 Expr *Init = cast<Expr>(Eval->Value); 12361 if (Init->isValueDependent()) 12362 return false; 12363 return IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, Context); 12364 } 12365 12366 12367 void Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Expr *E) { 12368 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is 12369 // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a 12370 // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 12371 // is immediately applied." This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue 12372 // conversion part. 12373 MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E->IgnoreParens()); 12374 12375 // If we are in a lambda, check if this DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr refers 12376 // to a variable that is a constant expression, and if so, identify it as 12377 // a reference to a variable that does not involve an odr-use of that 12378 // variable. 12379 if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) { 12380 Expr *SansParensExpr = E->IgnoreParens(); 12381 VarDecl *Var = nullptr; 12382 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SansParensExpr)) 12383 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getFoundDecl()); 12384 else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(SansParensExpr)) 12385 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 12386 12387 if (Var && IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, Context)) 12388 LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(SansParensExpr); 12389 } 12390 } 12391 12392 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) { 12393 if (!Res.isUsable()) 12394 return Res; 12395 12396 // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay 12397 // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the 12398 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion. In the one case where this doesn't happen 12399 // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway. 12400 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Res.get()); 12401 return Res; 12402 } 12403 12404 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() { 12405 for (llvm::SmallPtrSetIterator<Expr*> i = MaybeODRUseExprs.begin(), 12406 e = MaybeODRUseExprs.end(); 12407 i != e; ++i) { 12408 VarDecl *Var; 12409 SourceLocation Loc; 12410 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(*i)) { 12411 Var = cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 12412 Loc = DRE->getLocation(); 12413 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(*i)) { 12414 Var = cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 12415 Loc = ME->getMemberLoc(); 12416 } else { 12417 llvm_unreachable("Unexpcted expression"); 12418 } 12419 12420 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, *this, 12421 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex Pointer*/ nullptr); 12422 } 12423 12424 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 12425 } 12426 12427 12428 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 12429 VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) { 12430 assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E)) && 12431 "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced"); 12432 Var->setReferenced(); 12433 12434 // If the context is not potentially evaluated, this is not an odr-use and 12435 // does not trigger instantiation. 12436 if (!IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(SemaRef)) { 12437 if (SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) 12438 return; 12439 12440 // If we don't yet know whether this context is going to end up being an 12441 // evaluated context, and we're referencing a variable from an enclosing 12442 // scope, add a potential capture. 12443 // 12444 // FIXME: Is this necessary? These contexts are only used for default 12445 // arguments, where local variables can't be used. 12446 const bool RefersToEnclosingScope = 12447 (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() && 12448 Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && 12449 Var->hasLocalStorage()); 12450 if (!RefersToEnclosingScope) 12451 return; 12452 12453 if (LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI = SemaRef.getCurLambda()) { 12454 // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so 12455 // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any lvalue-to-rvalue 12456 // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use. 12457 // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed 12458 // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking 12459 // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant 12460 // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used). 12461 assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression."); 12462 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() || 12463 !IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) 12464 LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens()); 12465 } 12466 return; 12467 } 12468 12469 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 12470 dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var); 12471 assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) && 12472 "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization."); 12473 12474 // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member 12475 // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay 12476 // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used 12477 // in a constant expression. 12478 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind(); 12479 if (isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) { 12480 bool TryInstantiating = TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation; 12481 12482 if (TryInstantiating && !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) { 12483 if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) { 12484 // This is a modification of an existing AST node. Notify listeners. 12485 if (ASTMutationListener *L = SemaRef.getASTMutationListener()) 12486 L->StaticDataMemberInstantiated(Var); 12487 } else if (!Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) 12488 // Don't bother trying to instantiate it again, unless we might need 12489 // its initializer before we get to the end of the TU. 12490 TryInstantiating = false; 12491 } 12492 12493 if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) 12494 Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, Loc); 12495 12496 if (TryInstantiating) { 12497 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Var->getPointOfInstantiation(); 12498 bool InstantiationDependent = false; 12499 bool IsNonDependent = 12500 VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments( 12501 VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent) 12502 : true; 12503 12504 // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent. 12505 if (IsNonDependent) { 12506 if (Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) { 12507 // Do not defer instantiations of variables which could be used in a 12508 // constant expression. 12509 SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var); 12510 } else { 12511 SemaRef.PendingInstantiations 12512 .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation)); 12513 } 12514 } 12515 } 12516 } 12517 12518 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it satisfies 12519 // the requirements for appearing in a constant expression (5.19) and, if 12520 // it is an object, the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 12521 // is immediately applied." We check the first part here, and 12522 // Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue deals with the second part. 12523 // Note that we use the C++11 definition everywhere because nothing in 12524 // C++03 depends on whether we get the C++03 version correct. The second 12525 // part does not apply to references, since they are not objects. 12526 if (E && IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) { 12527 // A reference initialized by a constant expression can never be 12528 // odr-used, so simply ignore it. 12529 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType()) 12530 SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E); 12531 } else 12532 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef, 12533 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex ptr*/ nullptr); 12534 } 12535 12536 /// \brief Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 12537 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3). Note that this should not be 12538 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl. 12539 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) { 12540 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr); 12541 } 12542 12543 static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 12544 Decl *D, Expr *E, bool OdrUse) { 12545 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 12546 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E); 12547 return; 12548 } 12549 12550 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, OdrUse); 12551 12552 // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the 12553 // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call. 12554 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 12555 if (!ME) 12556 return; 12557 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 12558 if (!MD) 12559 return; 12560 const Expr *Base = ME->getBase(); 12561 const CXXRecordDecl *MostDerivedClassDecl = Base->getBestDynamicClassType(); 12562 if (!MostDerivedClassDecl) 12563 return; 12564 CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getCorrespondingMethodInClass(MostDerivedClassDecl); 12565 if (!DM || DM->isPure()) 12566 return; 12567 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, OdrUse); 12568 } 12569 12570 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr. 12571 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E) { 12572 // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed. 12573 // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even 12574 // if it's a qualified reference. 12575 bool OdrUse = true; 12576 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl())) 12577 if (Method->isVirtual()) 12578 OdrUse = false; 12579 MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse); 12580 } 12581 12582 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr. 12583 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) { 12584 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2: 12585 // A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated 12586 // expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by 12587 // overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated 12588 // expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its 12589 // name is not explicitly qualified. 12590 bool OdrUse = true; 12591 if (!E->hasQualifier()) { 12592 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl())) 12593 if (Method->isPure()) 12594 OdrUse = false; 12595 } 12596 SourceLocation Loc = E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ? 12597 E->getMemberLoc() : E->getLocStart(); 12598 MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, OdrUse); 12599 } 12600 12601 /// \brief Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration. It 12602 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for 12603 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a 12604 /// normal expression which refers to a variable. 12605 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, bool OdrUse) { 12606 if (OdrUse) { 12607 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 12608 MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD); 12609 return; 12610 } 12611 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 12612 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD); 12613 return; 12614 } 12615 } 12616 D->setReferenced(); 12617 } 12618 12619 namespace { 12620 // Mark all of the declarations referenced 12621 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding 12622 // of when we're entering 12623 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> { 12624 Sema &S; 12625 SourceLocation Loc; 12626 12627 public: 12628 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited; 12629 12630 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { } 12631 12632 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg); 12633 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T); 12634 }; 12635 } 12636 12637 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument( 12638 const TemplateArgument &Arg) { 12639 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) { 12640 if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl()) 12641 S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true); 12642 } 12643 12644 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg); 12645 } 12646 12647 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) { 12648 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec 12649 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) { 12650 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs(); 12651 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size()); 12652 } 12653 12654 return true; 12655 } 12656 12657 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) { 12658 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc); 12659 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T)); 12660 } 12661 12662 namespace { 12663 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by 12664 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 12665 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> { 12666 Sema &S; 12667 bool SkipLocalVariables; 12668 12669 public: 12670 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited; 12671 12672 EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables) 12673 : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { } 12674 12675 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 12676 // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't. 12677 if (SkipLocalVariables) { 12678 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl())) 12679 if (VD->hasLocalStorage()) 12680 return; 12681 } 12682 12683 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 12684 } 12685 12686 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 12687 S.MarkMemberReferenced(E); 12688 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E); 12689 } 12690 12691 void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) { 12692 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), 12693 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor())); 12694 Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 12695 } 12696 12697 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) { 12698 if (E->getOperatorNew()) 12699 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew()); 12700 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 12701 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 12702 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E); 12703 } 12704 12705 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) { 12706 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 12707 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 12708 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType()); 12709 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) { 12710 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl()); 12711 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), 12712 S.LookupDestructor(Record)); 12713 } 12714 12715 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E); 12716 } 12717 12718 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 12719 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor()); 12720 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 12721 } 12722 12723 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) { 12724 Visit(E->getExpr()); 12725 } 12726 12727 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 12728 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E); 12729 12730 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) 12731 S.UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E->getSubExpr()); 12732 } 12733 }; 12734 } 12735 12736 /// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any 12737 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 12738 /// 12739 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as 12740 /// 'referenced'. 12741 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E, 12742 bool SkipLocalVariables) { 12743 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E); 12744 } 12745 12746 /// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior 12747 /// of the program being compiled. 12748 /// 12749 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being 12750 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a 12751 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof() 12752 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not 12753 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or, 12754 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated 12755 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it 12756 /// later. 12757 /// 12758 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time 12759 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis. 12760 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures 12761 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid. 12762 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement, 12763 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) { 12764 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 12765 case Unevaluated: 12766 case UnevaluatedAbstract: 12767 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain. 12768 break; 12769 12770 case ConstantEvaluated: 12771 // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation. 12772 break; 12773 12774 case PotentiallyEvaluated: 12775 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 12776 if (Statement && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) { 12777 FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags. 12778 push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Statement)); 12779 } 12780 else 12781 Diag(Loc, PD); 12782 12783 return true; 12784 } 12785 12786 return false; 12787 } 12788 12789 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc, 12790 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) { 12791 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType()) 12792 return false; 12793 12794 // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return 12795 // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call. 12796 if (ExprEvalContexts.back().IsDecltype) { 12797 ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE); 12798 return false; 12799 } 12800 12801 class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser { 12802 FunctionDecl *FD; 12803 CallExpr *CE; 12804 12805 public: 12806 CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE) 12807 : FD(FD), CE(CE) { } 12808 12809 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 12810 if (!FD) { 12811 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return) 12812 << T << CE->getSourceRange(); 12813 return; 12814 } 12815 12816 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return) 12817 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T; 12818 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 12819 << FD->getDeclName(); 12820 } 12821 } Diagnoser(FD, CE); 12822 12823 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser)) 12824 return true; 12825 12826 return false; 12827 } 12828 12829 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses 12830 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want. 12831 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) { 12832 SourceLocation Loc; 12833 12834 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment; 12835 bool IsOrAssign = false; 12836 12837 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 12838 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign) 12839 return; 12840 12841 IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign; 12842 12843 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory. 12844 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME 12845 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 12846 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector(); 12847 12848 // self = [<foo> init...] 12849 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init) 12850 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 12851 12852 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject] 12853 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject") 12854 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 12855 } 12856 12857 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 12858 } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 12859 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual) 12860 return; 12861 12862 IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual; 12863 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 12864 } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E)) 12865 return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm()); 12866 else { 12867 // Not an assignment. 12868 return; 12869 } 12870 12871 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange(); 12872 12873 SourceLocation Open = E->getLocStart(); 12874 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 12875 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence) 12876 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(") 12877 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")"); 12878 12879 if (IsOrAssign) 12880 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison) 12881 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!="); 12882 else 12883 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison) 12884 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=="); 12885 } 12886 12887 /// \brief Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate 12888 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition. 12889 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) { 12890 // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro. 12891 SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getLocStart(); 12892 if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID()) 12893 return; 12894 // Don't warn for dependent expressions. 12895 if (ParenE->isTypeDependent()) 12896 return; 12897 12898 Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens(); 12899 12900 if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 12901 if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ && 12902 opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context) 12903 == Expr::MLV_Valid) { 12904 SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc(); 12905 12906 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange(); 12907 SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange(); 12908 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence) 12909 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin()) 12910 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd()); 12911 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign) 12912 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "="); 12913 } 12914 } 12915 12916 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 12917 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E); 12918 if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) 12919 DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE); 12920 12921 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 12922 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12923 E = result.get(); 12924 12925 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) { 12926 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 12927 return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E); // C++ 6.4p4 12928 12929 ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 12930 if (ERes.isInvalid()) 12931 return ExprError(); 12932 E = ERes.get(); 12933 12934 QualType T = E->getType(); 12935 if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1 12936 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar) 12937 << T << E->getSourceRange(); 12938 return ExprError(); 12939 } 12940 } 12941 12942 return E; 12943 } 12944 12945 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, 12946 Expr *SubExpr) { 12947 if (!SubExpr) 12948 return ExprError(); 12949 12950 return CheckBooleanCondition(SubExpr, Loc); 12951 } 12952 12953 namespace { 12954 /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression 12955 /// to have an appropriate type. 12956 struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction 12957 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> { 12958 12959 Sema &S; 12960 12961 RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 12962 12963 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 12964 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 12965 } 12966 12967 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 12968 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call) 12969 << E->getSourceRange(); 12970 return ExprError(); 12971 } 12972 12973 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 12974 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 12975 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 12976 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 12977 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12978 12979 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 12980 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 12981 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 12982 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 12983 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 12984 return E; 12985 } 12986 12987 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 12988 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 12989 } 12990 12991 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 12992 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 12993 } 12994 12995 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 12996 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 12997 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 12998 12999 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 13000 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 13001 E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType())); 13002 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13003 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13004 return E; 13005 } 13006 13007 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 13008 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E); 13009 13010 E->setType(VD->getType()); 13011 13012 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13013 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 13014 !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) && 13015 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance())) 13016 E->setValueKind(VK_LValue); 13017 13018 return E; 13019 } 13020 13021 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 13022 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 13023 } 13024 13025 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 13026 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 13027 } 13028 }; 13029 } 13030 13031 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 13032 /// to have a function type. 13033 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) { 13034 ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr); 13035 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13036 return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get()); 13037 } 13038 13039 namespace { 13040 /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype 13041 /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring 13042 /// expression. Strict preservation of the original source 13043 /// structure is not a goal. 13044 struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr 13045 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> { 13046 13047 Sema &S; 13048 13049 /// The current destination type. 13050 QualType DestType; 13051 13052 RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType) 13053 : S(S), DestType(CastType) {} 13054 13055 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 13056 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 13057 } 13058 13059 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 13060 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 13061 << E->getSourceRange(); 13062 return ExprError(); 13063 } 13064 13065 ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E); 13066 ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E); 13067 13068 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 13069 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 13070 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 13071 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13072 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13073 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 13074 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 13075 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 13076 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 13077 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13078 return E; 13079 } 13080 13081 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 13082 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13083 } 13084 13085 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 13086 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 13087 } 13088 13089 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 13090 const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>(); 13091 if (!Ptr) { 13092 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof) 13093 << E->getSourceRange(); 13094 return ExprError(); 13095 } 13096 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13097 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13098 E->setType(DestType); 13099 13100 // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type. 13101 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 13102 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13103 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13104 E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get()); 13105 return E; 13106 } 13107 13108 ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E); 13109 13110 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD); 13111 13112 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 13113 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 13114 } 13115 13116 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 13117 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 13118 } 13119 }; 13120 } 13121 13122 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype. 13123 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 13124 Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee(); 13125 13126 enum FnKind { 13127 FK_MemberFunction, 13128 FK_FunctionPointer, 13129 FK_BlockPointer 13130 }; 13131 13132 FnKind Kind; 13133 QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType(); 13134 if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) { 13135 assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)); 13136 Kind = FK_MemberFunction; 13137 CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr); 13138 } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 13139 CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 13140 Kind = FK_FunctionPointer; 13141 } else { 13142 CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 13143 Kind = FK_BlockPointer; 13144 } 13145 const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>(); 13146 13147 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function. 13148 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 13149 unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function; 13150 if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer) 13151 diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function; 13152 13153 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID) 13154 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 13155 return ExprError(); 13156 } 13157 13158 // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result. 13159 E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context)); 13160 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 13161 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13162 13163 // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType. 13164 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 13165 if (Proto) { 13166 // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when 13167 // it has no idea what a function's signature is. 13168 // 13169 // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R 13170 // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++ 13171 // would foul up all sorts of assumptions. However, we cannot 13172 // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we 13173 // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see 13174 // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic. 13175 // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to 13176 // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype 13177 // "A foo(B,C,D,...);". The only known exception is with the 13178 // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl 13179 // regardless of its normal CC. Therefore we change the parameter 13180 // types to match the types of the arguments. 13181 // 13182 // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the 13183 // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST. 13184 13185 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes(); 13186 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes; 13187 if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case 13188 ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs()); 13189 for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) { 13190 Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i); 13191 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 13192 if (E->isLValue()) { 13193 ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType); 13194 } else if (E->isXValue()) { 13195 ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType); 13196 } 13197 ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType); 13198 } 13199 ParamTypes = ArgTypes; 13200 } 13201 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes, 13202 Proto->getExtProtoInfo()); 13203 } else { 13204 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType, 13205 FnType->getExtInfo()); 13206 } 13207 13208 // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type. 13209 switch (Kind) { 13210 case FK_MemberFunction: 13211 // Nothing to do. 13212 break; 13213 13214 case FK_FunctionPointer: 13215 DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType); 13216 break; 13217 13218 case FK_BlockPointer: 13219 DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType); 13220 break; 13221 } 13222 13223 // Finally, we can recurse. 13224 ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr); 13225 if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13226 E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get()); 13227 13228 // Bind a temporary if necessary. 13229 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 13230 } 13231 13232 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) { 13233 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call. 13234 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 13235 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function) 13236 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 13237 return ExprError(); 13238 } 13239 13240 // Rewrite the method result type if available. 13241 if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) { 13242 assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy); 13243 Method->setReturnType(DestType); 13244 } 13245 13246 // Change the type of the message. 13247 E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType()); 13248 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 13249 13250 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 13251 } 13252 13253 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 13254 // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay. 13255 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) { 13256 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13257 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13258 13259 E->setType(DestType); 13260 13261 // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type. 13262 DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 13263 13264 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13265 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13266 13267 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 13268 return E; 13269 } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 13270 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 13271 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 13272 13273 assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType())); 13274 13275 E->setType(DestType); 13276 13277 // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such. 13278 DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType); 13279 13280 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 13281 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13282 13283 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 13284 return E; 13285 } else { 13286 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!"); 13287 } 13288 } 13289 13290 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 13291 ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue; 13292 QualType Type = DestType; 13293 13294 // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls: 13295 13296 // - functions 13297 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) { 13298 if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 13299 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 13300 ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD); 13301 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13302 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type, 13303 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue); 13304 } 13305 13306 if (!Type->isFunctionType()) { 13307 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function) 13308 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 13309 return ExprError(); 13310 } 13311 13312 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 13313 if (MD->isInstance()) { 13314 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 13315 Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy; 13316 } 13317 13318 // Function references aren't l-values in C. 13319 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13320 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 13321 13322 // - variables 13323 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) { 13324 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 13325 Type = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 13326 } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) { 13327 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type) 13328 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 13329 return ExprError(); 13330 } 13331 13332 // - nothing else 13333 } else { 13334 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl) 13335 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 13336 return ExprError(); 13337 } 13338 13339 // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but 13340 // also really dangerous. 13341 VD->setType(DestType); 13342 E->setType(Type); 13343 E->setValueKind(ValueKind); 13344 return E; 13345 } 13346 13347 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type. We intentionally only 13348 /// trigger this for C-style casts. 13349 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType, 13350 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind, 13351 ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) { 13352 // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch. 13353 ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr); 13354 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13355 13356 CastExpr = result.get(); 13357 VK = CastExpr->getValueKind(); 13358 CastKind = CK_NoOp; 13359 13360 return CastExpr; 13361 } 13362 13363 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) { 13364 return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E); 13365 } 13366 13367 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc, 13368 Expr *arg, QualType ¶mType) { 13369 // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of 13370 // any sort, just do default argument promotion. 13371 ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens()); 13372 if (!castArg) { 13373 ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg); 13374 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13375 paramType = result.get()->getType(); 13376 return result; 13377 } 13378 13379 // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast. 13380 assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType()); 13381 paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten(); 13382 13383 // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type. 13384 InitializedEntity entity = 13385 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType, 13386 /*consumed*/ false); 13387 return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg); 13388 } 13389 13390 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 13391 Expr *orig = E; 13392 unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any; 13393 while (true) { 13394 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 13395 if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 13396 E = call->getCallee(); 13397 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 13398 } else { 13399 break; 13400 } 13401 } 13402 13403 SourceLocation loc; 13404 NamedDecl *d; 13405 if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 13406 loc = ref->getLocation(); 13407 d = ref->getDecl(); 13408 } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 13409 loc = mem->getMemberLoc(); 13410 d = mem->getMemberDecl(); 13411 } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) { 13412 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 13413 loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc(); 13414 d = msg->getMethodDecl(); 13415 if (!d) { 13416 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method) 13417 << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector() 13418 << orig->getSourceRange(); 13419 return ExprError(); 13420 } 13421 } else { 13422 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 13423 << E->getSourceRange(); 13424 return ExprError(); 13425 } 13426 13427 S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange(); 13428 13429 // Never recoverable. 13430 return ExprError(); 13431 } 13432 13433 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found. 13434 /// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible. 13435 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) { 13436 const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType(); 13437 if (!placeholderType) return E; 13438 13439 switch (placeholderType->getKind()) { 13440 13441 // Overloaded expressions. 13442 case BuiltinType::Overload: { 13443 // Try to resolve a single function template specialization. 13444 // This is obligatory. 13445 ExprResult result = E; 13446 if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(result, false)) { 13447 return result; 13448 13449 // If that failed, try to recover with a call. 13450 } else { 13451 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable), 13452 /*complain*/ true); 13453 return result; 13454 } 13455 } 13456 13457 // Bound member functions. 13458 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: { 13459 ExprResult result = E; 13460 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function), 13461 /*complain*/ true); 13462 return result; 13463 } 13464 13465 // ARC unbridged casts. 13466 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: { 13467 Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 13468 diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast); 13469 return realCast; 13470 } 13471 13472 // Expressions of unknown type. 13473 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 13474 return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E); 13475 13476 // Pseudo-objects. 13477 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 13478 return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E); 13479 13480 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: 13481 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use); 13482 return ExprError(); 13483 13484 // Everything else should be impossible. 13485 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) \ 13486 case BuiltinType::Id: 13487 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) 13488 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 13489 break; 13490 } 13491 13492 llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!"); 13493 } 13494 13495 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) { 13496 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 13497 return true; 13498 if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) 13499 return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType(); 13500 return false; 13501 } 13502 13503 /// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals. 13504 ExprResult 13505 Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 13506 assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) && 13507 "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!"); 13508 QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy; 13509 if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) { 13510 LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc, 13511 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 13512 if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) { 13513 NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl(); 13514 if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND)) 13515 Context.setBOOLDecl(TD); 13516 } 13517 } 13518 if (Context.getBOOLDecl()) 13519 BoolT = Context.getBOOLType(); 13520 return new (Context) 13521 ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc); 13522 } 13523